Network Working Group                                             J. Moy
Request for Comments: 2178                  Cascade Communications Corp.
Obsoletes: 1583                                                July 1997
Category: Standards Track


                            OSPF Version 2

Status of this Memo

  This document specifies an Internet standards track protocol for the
  Internet community, and requests discussion and suggestions for
  improvements.  Please refer to the current edition of the "Internet
  Official Protocol Standards" (STD 1) for the standardization state
  and status of this protocol.  Distribution of this memo is unlimited.

Abstract

  This memo documents version 2 of the OSPF protocol. OSPF is a link-
  state routing protocol.  It is designed to be run internal to a
  single Autonomous System.  Each OSPF router maintains an identical
  database describing the Autonomous System's topology.  From this
  database, a routing table is calculated by constructing a shortest-
  path tree.

  OSPF recalculates routes quickly in the face of topological changes,
  utilizing a minimum of routing protocol traffic.  OSPF provides
  support for equal-cost multipath.  An area routing capability is
  provided, enabling an additional level of routing protection and a
  reduction in routing protocol traffic.  In addition, all OSPF routing
  protocol exchanges are authenticated.

  The differences between this memo and RFC 1583 are explained in
  Appendix G. All differences are backward-compatible in nature.
  Implementations of this memo and of RFC 1583 will interoperate.

  Please send comments to [email protected].

Table of Contents

   1        Introduction ........................................... 5
   1.1      Protocol Overview ...................................... 5
   1.2      Definitions of commonly used terms ..................... 6
   1.3      Brief history of link-state routing technology ........  9
   1.4      Organization of this document ......................... 10
   1.5      Acknowledgments ....................................... 11
   2        The link-state database: organization and calculations  11
   2.1      Representation of routers and networks ................ 11



Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 1]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   2.1.1    Representation of non-broadcast networks .............. 13
   2.1.2    An example link-state database ........................ 14
   2.2      The shortest-path tree ................................ 18
   2.3      Use of external routing information ................... 20
   2.4      Equal-cost multipath .................................. 22
   3        Splitting the AS into Areas ........................... 22
   3.1      The backbone of the Autonomous System ................. 23
   3.2      Inter-area routing .................................... 23
   3.3      Classification of routers ............................. 24
   3.4      A sample area configuration ........................... 25
   3.5      IP subnetting support ................................. 31
   3.6      Supporting stub areas ................................. 32
   3.7      Partitions of areas ................................... 33
   4        Functional Summary .................................... 34
   4.1      Inter-area routing .................................... 35
   4.2      AS external routes .................................... 35
   4.3      Routing protocol packets .............................. 35
   4.4      Basic implementation requirements ..................... 38
   4.5      Optional OSPF capabilities ............................ 39
   5        Protocol data structures .............................. 40
   6        The Area Data Structure ............................... 42
   7        Bringing Up Adjacencies ............................... 44
   7.1      The Hello Protocol .................................... 44
   7.2      The Synchronization of Databases ...................... 45
   7.3      The Designated Router ................................. 46
   7.4      The Backup Designated Router .......................... 47
   7.5      The graph of adjacencies .............................. 48
   8        Protocol Packet Processing ............................ 49
   8.1      Sending protocol packets .............................. 49
   8.2      Receiving protocol packets ............................ 51
   9        The Interface Data Structure .......................... 54
   9.1      Interface states ...................................... 57
   9.2      Events causing interface state changes ................ 59
   9.3      The Interface state machine ........................... 61
   9.4      Electing the Designated Router ........................ 64
   9.5      Sending Hello packets ................................. 66
   9.5.1    Sending Hello packets on NBMA networks ................ 67
   10       The Neighbor Data Structure ........................... 68
   10.1     Neighbor states ....................................... 70
   10.2     Events causing neighbor state changes ................. 75
   10.3     The Neighbor state machine ............................ 76
   10.4     Whether tocome adjacent    ............................ 82
   10.5     Receiving Hello Packets ............................... 83
   10.6     Receiving Database Description Packets ................ 85
   10.7     Receiving Link State Request Packets .................. 88
   10.8     Sending Database Description Packets .................. 89
   10.9     Sending Link State Request Packets .................... 90
   10.10    An Example ............................................ 91



Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 2]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   11       The Routing Table Structure ........................... 93
   11.1     Routing table lookup .................................. 96
   11.2     Sample routing table, without areas ................... 97
   11.3     Sample routing table, with areas ...................... 97
   12       Link State Advertisements (LSAs) ......................100
   12.1     The LSA Header ........................................100
   12.1.1   LS age ............................................... 101
   12.1.2   Options .............................................. 101
   12.1.3   LS type .............................................. 102
   12.1.4   Link State ID ........................................ 102
   12.1.5   Advertising Router ................................... 104
   12.1.6   LS sequence number ................................... 104
   12.1.7   LS checksum .......................................... 105
   12.2     The link state database .............................. 105
   12.3     Representation of TOS ................................ 106
   12.4     Originating LSAs ..................................... 107
   12.4.1   Router-LSAs .......................................... 110
   12.4.1.1 Describing point-to-point interfaces ................. 112
   12.4.1.2 Describing broadcast and NBMA interfaces ............. 113
   12.4.1.3 Describing virtual links ............................. 113
   12.4.1.4 Describing Point-to-MultiPoint interfaces ............ 114
   12.4.1.5 Examples of router-LSAs .............................. 114
   12.4.2   Network-LSAs ......................................... 116
   12.4.2.1 Examples of network-LSAs ............................. 116
   12.4.3   Summary-LSAs ......................................... 117
   12.4.3.1 Originating summary-LSAs into stub areas ............. 119
   12.4.3.2 Examples of summary-LSAs ............................. 119
   12.4.4   AS-external-LSAs ..................................... 120
   12.4.4.1 Examples of AS-external-LSAs ......................... 121
   13       The Flooding Procedure ............................... 122
   13.1     Determining which LSA is newer ....................... 126
   13.2     Installing LSAs in the database ...................... 127
   13.3     Next step in the flooding procedure .................. 128
   13.4     Receiving self-originated LSAs ....................... 130
   13.5     Sending Link State Acknowledgment packets ............ 131
   13.6     Retransmitting LSAs .................................. 133
   13.7     Receiving link state acknowledgments ................. 134
   14       Aging The Link State Database ........................ 134
   14.1     Premature aging of LSAs .............................. 135
   15       Virtual Links ........................................ 135
   16       Calculation of the routing table ..................... 137
   16.1     Calculating the shortest-path tree for an area ....... 138
   16.1.1   The next hop calculation ............................. 144
   16.2     Calculating the inter-area routes .................... 145
   16.3     Examining transit areas' summary-LSAs ................ 146
   16.4     Calculating AS external routes ....................... 149
   16.4.1   External path preferences ............................ 151
   16.5     Incremental updates -- summary-LSAs .................. 151



Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 3]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   16.6     Incremental updates -- AS-external-LSAs .............. 152
   16.7     Events generated as a result of routing table changes  153
   16.8     Equal-cost multipath ................................. 154
            Footnotes ............................................ 155
            References ........................................... 158
   A        OSPF data formats .................................... 160
   A.1      Encapsulation of OSPF packets ........................ 160
   A.2      The Options field .................................... 162
   A.3      OSPF Packet Formats .................................. 163
   A.3.1    The OSPF packet header ............................... 164
   A.3.2    The Hello packet ..................................... 166
   A.3.3    The Database Description packet ...................... 168
   A.3.4    The Link State Request packet ........................ 170
   A.3.5    The Link State Update packet ......................... 171
   A.3.6    The Link State Acknowledgment packet ................. 172
   A.4      LSA formats .......................................... 173
   A.4.1    The LSA header ....................................... 174
   A.4.2    Router-LSAs .......................................... 176
   A.4.3    Network-LSAs ......................................... 179
   A.4.4    Summary-LSAs ......................................... 180
   A.4.5    AS-external-LSAs ..................................... 182
   B        Architectural Constants .............................. 184
   C        Configurable Constants ............................... 186
   C.1      Global parameters .................................... 186
   C.2      Area parameters ...................................... 187
   C.3      Router interface parameters .......................... 188
   C.4      Virtual link parameters .............................. 190
   C.5      NBMA network parameters .............................. 191
   C.6      Point-to-MultiPoint network parameters ............... 191
   C.7      Host route parameters ................................ 192
   D        Authentication ....................................... 193
   D.1      Null authentication .................................. 193
   D.2      Simple password authentication ....................... 193
   D.3      Cryptographic authentication ......................... 194
   D.4      Message generation ................................... 196
   D.4.1    Generating Null authentication ....................... 196
   D.4.2    Generating Simple password authentication ............ 197
   D.4.3    Generating Cryptographic authentication .............. 197
   D.5      Message verification ................................. 198
   D.5.1    Verifying Null authentication ........................ 199
   D.5.2    Verifying Simple password authentication ............. 199
   D.5.3    Verifying Cryptographic authentication ............... 199
   E        An algorithm for assigning Link State IDs ............ 201
   F        Multiple interfaces to the same network/subnet ....... 203
   G        Differences from RFC 1583 ............................ 204
   G.1      Enhancements to OSPF authentication .................. 204
   G.2      Addition of Point-to-MultiPoint interface ............ 204
   G.3      Support for overlapping area ranges .................. 205



Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 4]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   G.4      A modification to the flooding algorithm ............. 206
   G.5      Introduction of the MinLSArrival constant ............ 206
   G.6      Optionally advertising point-to-point links as subnets 207
   G.7      Advertising same external route from multiple areas .. 207
   G.8      Retransmission of initial Database Description packets 209
   G.9      Detecting interface MTU mismatches ................... 209
   G.10     Deleting the TOS routing option ...................... 209
            Security Considerations .............................. 210
            Author's Address ..................................... 211

1.  Introduction

  This document is a specification of the Open Shortest Path First
  (OSPF) TCP/IP internet routing protocol.  OSPF is classified as an
  Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP).  This means that it distributes
  routing information between routers belonging to a single Autonomous
  System.  The OSPF protocol is based on link-state or SPF technology.
  This is a departure from the Bellman-Ford base used by traditional
  TCP/IP internet routing protocols.

  The OSPF protocol was developed by the OSPF working group of the
  Internet Engineering Task Force.  It has been designed expressly for
  the TCP/IP internet environment, including explicit support for CIDR
  and the tagging of externally-derived routing information. OSPF also
  provides for the authentication of routing updates, and utilizes IP
  multicast when sending/receiving the updates.  In addition, much work
  has been done to produce a protocol that responds quickly to topology
  changes, yet involves small amounts of routing protocol traffic.

1.1.  Protocol overview

  OSPF routes IP packets based solely on the destination IP address
  found in the IP packet header. IP packets are routed "as is" -- they
  are not encapsulated in any further protocol headers as they transit
  the Autonomous System. OSPF is a dynamic routing protocol.  It
  quickly detects topological changes in the AS (such as router
  interface failures) and calculates new loop-free routes after a
  period of convergence.  This period of convergence is short and
  involves a minimum of routing traffic.

  In a link-state routing protocol, each router maintains a database
  describing the Autonomous System's topology.  This database is
  referred to as the link-state database. Each participating router has
  an identical database.  Each individual piece of this database is a
  particular router's local state (e.g., the router's usable interfaces
  and reachable neighbors).  The router distributes its local state
  throughout the Autonomous System by flooding.




Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 5]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  All routers run the exact same algorithm, in parallel. From the
  link-state database, each router constructs a tree of shortest paths
  with itself as root.  This shortest-path tree gives the route to each
  destination in the Autonomous System.  Externally derived routing
  information appears on the tree as leaves.

  When several equal-cost routes to a destination exist, traffic is
  distributed equally among them.  The cost of a route is described by
  a single dimensionless metric.

  OSPF allows sets of networks to be grouped together.  Such a grouping
  is called an area.  The topology of an area is hidden from the rest
  of the Autonomous System.  This information hiding enables a
  significant reduction in routing traffic.  Also, routing within the
  area is determined only by the area's own topology, lending the area
  protection from bad routing data.  An area is a generalization of an
  IP subnetted network.

  OSPF enables the flexible configuration of IP subnets.  Each route
  distributed by OSPF has a destination and mask.  Two different
  subnets of the same IP network number may have different sizes (i.e.,
  different masks).  This is commonly referred to as variable length
  subnetting.  A packet is routed to the best (i.e., longest or most
  specific) match.  Host routes are considered to be subnets whose
  masks are "all ones" (0xffffffff).

  All OSPF protocol exchanges are authenticated.  This means that only
  trusted routers can participate in the Autonomous System's routing.
  A variety of authentication schemes can be used; in fact, separate
  authentication schemes can be configured for each IP subnet.

  Externally derived routing data (e.g., routes learned from an
  Exterior Gateway Protocol such as BGP; see [Ref23]) is advertised
  throughout the Autonomous System.  This externally derived data is
  kept separate from the OSPF protocol's link state data.  Each
  external route can also be tagged by the advertising router, enabling
  the passing of additional information between routers on the boundary
  of the Autonomous System.

1.2.  Definitions of commonly used terms

  This section provides definitions for terms that have a specific
  meaning to the OSPF protocol and that are used throughout the text.
  The reader unfamiliar with the Internet Protocol Suite is referred to
  [Ref13] for an introduction to IP.






Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 6]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Router
     A level three Internet Protocol packet switch.  Formerly called a
     gateway in much of the IP literature.

  Autonomous System
     A group of routers exchanging routing information via a common
     routing protocol.  Abbreviated as AS.

  Interior Gateway Protocol
     The routing protocol spoken by the routers belonging to an
     Autonomous system. Abbreviated as IGP.  Each Autonomous System has
     a single IGP.  Separate Autonomous Systems may be running
     different IGPs.

  Router ID
     A 32-bit number assigned to each router running the OSPF protocol.
     This number uniquely identifies the router within an Autonomous
     System.

  Network
     In this memo, an IP network/subnet/supernet.  It is possible for
     one physical network to be assigned multiple IP network/subnet
     numbers.  We consider these to be separate networks.  Point-to-
     point physical networks are an exception - they are considered a
     single network no matter how many (if any at all) IP
     network/subnet numbers are assigned to them.

  Network mask
     A 32-bit number indicating the range of IP addresses residing on a
     single IP network/subnet/supernet.  This specification displays
     network masks as hexadecimal numbers.  For example, the network
     mask for a class C IP network is displayed as 0xffffff00.  Such a
     mask is often displayed elsewhere in the literature as
     255.255.255.0.

  Point-to-point networks
     A network that joins a single pair of routers.  A 56Kb serial line
     is an example of a point-to-point network.













Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 7]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Broadcast networks
     Networks supporting many (more than two) attached routers,
     together with the capability to address a single physical message
     to all of the attached routers (broadcast).  Neighboring routers
     are discovered dynamically on these nets using OSPF's Hello
     Protocol.  The Hello Protocol itself takes advantage of the
     broadcast capability.  The OSPF protocol makes further use of
     multicast capabilities, if they exist.  Each pair of routers on a
     broadcast network is assumed to be able to communicate directly.
     An ethernet is an example of a broadcast network.

  Non-broadcast networks
     Networks supporting many (more than two) routers, but having no
     broadcast capability.  Neighboring routers are maintained on these
     nets using OSPF's Hello Protocol. However, due to the lack of
     broadcast capability, some configuration information may be
     necessary to aid in the discovery of neighbors. On non-broadcast
     networks, OSPF protocol packets that are normally multicast need
     to be sent to each neighboring router, in turn. An X.25 Public
     Data Network (PDN) is an example of a non-broadcast network.

     OSPF runs in one of two modes over non-broadcast networks.  The
     first mode, called non-broadcast multi-access or NBMA, simulates
     the operation of OSPF on a broadcast network. The second mode,
     called Point-to-MultiPoint, treats the non-broadcast network as a
     collection of point-to-point links.  Non-broadcast networks are
     referred to as NBMA networks or Point-to-MultiPoint networks,
     depending on OSPF's mode of operation over the network.

  Interface
     The connection between a router and one of its attached networks.
     An interface has state information associated with it, which is
     obtained from the underlying lower level protocols and the routing
     protocol itself.  An interface to a network has associated with it
     a single IP address and mask (unless the network is an unnumbered
     point-to-point network).  An interface is sometimes also referred
     to as a link.

  Neighboring routers
     Two routers that have interfaces to a common network.  Neighbor
     relationships are maintained by, and usually dynamically
     discovered by, OSPF's Hello Protocol.

  Adjacency
     A relationship formed between selected neighboring routers for the
     purpose of exchanging routing information.  Not every pair of
     neighboring routers become adjacent.




Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 8]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Link state advertisement
     Unit of data describing the local state of a router or network.
     For a router, this includes the state of the router's interfaces
     and adjacencies.  Each link state advertisement is flooded
     throughout the routing domain. The collected link state
     advertisements of all routers and networks forms the protocol's
     link state database.  Throughout this memo, link state
     advertisement is abbreviated as LSA.

  Hello Protocol
     The part of the OSPF protocol used to establish and maintain
     neighbor relationships.  On broadcast networks the Hello Protocol
     can also dynamically discover neighboring routers.

  Flooding
     The part of the OSPF protocol that distributes and synchronizes
     the link-state database between OSPF routers.

  Designated Router
     Each broadcast and NBMA network that has at least two attached
     routers has a Designated Router.  The Designated Router generates
     an LSA for the network and has other special responsibilities in
     the running of the protocol.  The Designated Router is elected by
     the Hello Protocol.

     The Designated Router concept enables a reduction in the number of
     adjacencies required on a broadcast or NBMA network.  This in turn
     reduces the amount of routing protocol traffic and the size of the
     link-state database.

  Lower-level protocols
     The underlying network access protocols that provide services to
     the Internet Protocol and in turn the OSPF protocol.  Examples of
     these are the X.25 packet and frame levels for X.25 PDNs, and the
     ethernet data link layer for ethernets.

1.3.  Brief history of link-state routing technology

  OSPF is a link state routing protocol.  Such protocols are also
  referred to in the literature as SPF-based or distributed-database
  protocols.  This section gives a brief description of the
  developments in link-state technology that have influenced the OSPF
  protocol.

  The first link-state routing protocol was developed for use in the
  ARPANET packet switching network.  This protocol is described in
  [Ref3].  It has formed the starting point for all other link-state
  protocols.  The homogeneous ARPANET environment, i.e., single-vendor



Moy                         Standards Track                     [Page 9]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  packet switches connected by synchronous serial lines, simplified the
  design and implementation of the original protocol.

  Modifications to this protocol were proposed in [Ref4].  These
  modifications dealt with increasing the fault tolerance of the
  routing protocol through, among other things, adding a checksum to
  the LSAs (thereby detecting database corruption).  The paper also
  included means for reducing the routing traffic overhead in a link-
  state protocol.  This was accomplished by introducing mechanisms
  which enabled the interval between LSA originations to be increased
  by an order of magnitude.

  A link-state algorithm has also been proposed for use as an ISO IS-IS
  routing protocol.  This protocol is described in [Ref2].  The
  protocol includes methods for data and routing traffic reduction when
  operating over broadcast networks.  This is accomplished by election
  of a Designated Router for each broadcast network, which then
  originates an LSA for the network.

  The OSPF Working Group of the IETF has extended this work in
  developing the OSPF protocol.  The Designated Router concept has been
  greatly enhanced to further reduce the amount of routing traffic
  required.  Multicast capabilities are utilized for additional routing
  bandwidth reduction.  An area routing scheme has been developed
  enabling information hiding/protection/reduction.  Finally, the
  algorithms have been tailored for efficient operation in TCP/IP
  internets.

1.4.  Organization of this document

  The first three sections of this specification give a general
  overview of the protocol's capabilities and functions.  Sections 4-16
  explain the protocol's mechanisms in detail.  Packet formats,
  protocol constants and configuration items are specified in the
  appendices.

  Labels such as HelloInterval encountered in the text refer to
  protocol constants.  They may or may not be configurable.
  Architectural constants are summarized in Appendix B.  Configurable
  constants are summarized in Appendix C.

  The detailed specification of the protocol is presented in terms of
  data structures.  This is done in order to make the explanation more
  precise.  Implementations of the protocol are required to support the
  functionality described, but need not use the precise data structures
  that appear in this memo.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 10]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


1.5.  Acknowledgments

  The author would like to thank Ran Atkinson, Fred Baker, Jeffrey
  Burgan, Rob Coltun, Dino Farinacci, Vince Fuller, Phanindra
  Jujjavarapu, Milo Medin, Tom Pusateri, Kannan Varadhan, Zhaohui Zhang
  and the rest of the OSPF Working Group for the ideas and support they
  have given to this project.

  The OSPF Point-to-MultiPoint interface is based on work done by Fred
  Baker.

  The OSPF Cryptographic Authentication option was developed by Fred
  Baker and Ran Atkinson.

2.  The Link-state Database: organization and calculations

  The following subsections describe the organization of OSPF's link-
  state database, and the routing calculations that are performed on
  the database in order to produce a router's routing table.

2.1.  Representation of routers and networks

  The Autonomous System's link-state database describes a directed
  graph.  The vertices of the graph consist of routers and networks.  A
  graph edge connects two routers when they are attached via a physical
  point-to-point network.  An edge connecting a router to a network
  indicates that the router has an interface on the network. Networks
  can be either transit or stub networks. Transit networks are those
  capable of carrying data traffic that is neither locally originated
  nor locally destined. A transit network is represented by a graph
  vertex having both incoming and outgoing edges. A stub network's
  vertex has only incoming edges.

  The neighborhood of each network node in the graph depends on the
  network's type (point-to-point, broadcast, NBMA or Point-to-
  MultiPoint) and the number of routers having an interface to the
  network.  Three cases are depicted in Figure 1a.  Rectangles indicate
  routers.  Circles and oblongs indicate networks.  Router names are
  prefixed with the letters RT and network names with the letter N.
  Router interface names are prefixed by the letter I.  Lines between
  routers indicate point-to-point networks.  The left side of the
  figure shows networks with their connected routers, with the
  resulting graphs shown on the right.








Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 11]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                                                 **FROM**

                                          *      |RT1|RT2|
               +---+Ia    +---+           *   ------------
               |RT1|------|RT2|           T   RT1|   | X |
               +---+    Ib+---+           O   RT2| X |   |
                                          *    Ia|   | X |
                                          *    Ib| X |   |

                   Physical point-to-point networks

                                                 **FROM**
                     +---+                *
                     |RT7|                *      |RT7| N3|
                     +---+                T   ------------
                       |                  O   RT7|   |   |
           +----------------------+       *    N3| X |   |
                      N3                  *

                            Stub networks

               +---+      +---+
               |RT3|      |RT4|              |RT3|RT4|RT5|RT6|N2 |
               +---+      +---+        *  ------------------------
                 |    N2    |          *  RT3|   |   |   |   | X |
           +----------------------+    T  RT4|   |   |   |   | X |
                 |          |          O  RT5|   |   |   |   | X |
               +---+      +---+        *  RT6|   |   |   |   | X |
               |RT5|      |RT6|        *   N2| X | X | X | X |   |
               +---+      +---+

                      Broadcast or NBMA networks

                  Figure 1a: Network map components

  Networks and routers are represented by vertices.  An edge connects
  Vertex A to Vertex B iff the intersection of Column A and Row B is
  marked with an X.

  The top of Figure 1a shows two routers connected by a point-to-point
  link. In the resulting link-state database graph, the two router
  vertices are directly connected by a pair of edges, one in each
  direction. Interfaces to point-to-point networks need not be assigned
  IP addresses.  When interface addresses are assigned, they are
  modelled as stub links, with each router advertising a stub
  connection to the other router's interface address. Optionally, an IP





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 12]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  subnet can be assigned to the point-to-point network. In this case,
  both routers advertise a stub link to the IP subnet, instead of
  advertising each others' IP interface addresses.

  The middle of Figure 1a shows a network with only one attached router
  (i.e., a stub network). In this case, the network appears on the end
  of a stub connection in the link-state database's graph.

  When multiple routers are attached to a broadcast network, the link-
  state database graph shows all routers bidirectionally connected to
  the network vertex. This is pictured at the bottom of Figure 1a.

  Each network (stub or transit) in the graph has an IP address and
  associated network mask.  The mask indicates the number of nodes on
  the network.  Hosts attached directly to routers (referred to as host
  routes) appear on the graph as stub networks.  The network mask for a
  host route is always 0xffffffff, which indicates the presence of a
  single node.

2.1.1. Representation of non-broadcast networks

  As mentioned previously, OSPF can run over non-broadcast networks in
  one of two modes: NBMA or Point-to-MultiPoint.  The choice of mode
  determines the way that the Hello protocol and flooding work over the
  non-broadcast network, and the way that the network is represented in
  the link-state database.

  In NBMA mode, OSPF emulates operation over a broadcast network: a
  Designated Router is elected for the NBMA network, and the Designated
  Router originates an LSA for the network. The graph representation
  for broadcast networks and NBMA networks is identical. This
  representation is pictured in the middle of Figure 1a.

  NBMA mode is the most efficient way to run OSPF over non-broadcast
  networks, both in terms of link-state database size and in terms of
  the amount of routing protocol traffic.  However, it has one
  significant restriction: it requires all routers attached to the NBMA
  network to be able to communicate directly. This restriction may be
  met on some non-broadcast networks, such as an ATM subnet utilizing
  SVCs. But it is often not met on other non-broadcast networks, such
  as PVC-only Frame Relay networks. On non-broadcast networks where not
  all routers can communicate directly you can break the non-broadcast
  network into logical subnets, with the routers on each subnet being
  able to communicate directly, and then run each separate subnet as an
  NBMA network (see [Ref15]). This however requires quite a bit of
  administrative overhead, and is prone to misconfiguration. It is
  probably better to run such a non-broadcast network in Point-to-
  Multipoint mode.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 13]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  In Point-to-MultiPoint mode, OSPF treats all router-to-router
  connections over the non-broadcast network as if they were point-to-
  point links. No Designated Router is elected for the network, nor is
  there an LSA generated for the network. In fact, a vertex for the
  Point-to-MultiPoint network does not appear in the graph of the
  link-state database.

  Figure 1b illustrates the link-state database representation of a
  Point-to-MultiPoint network. On the left side of the figure, a
  Point-to-MultiPoint network is pictured. It is assumed that all
  routers can communicate directly, except for routers RT4 and RT5. I3
  though I6 indicate the routers' IP interface addresses on the Point-
  to-MultiPoint network.  In the graphical representation of the link-
  state database, routers that can communicate directly over the
  Point-to-MultiPoint network are joined by bidirectional edges, and
  each router also has a stub connection to its own IP interface
  address (which is in contrast to the representation of real point-
  to-point links; see Figure 1a).

  On some non-broadcast networks, use of Point-to-MultiPoint mode and
  data-link protocols such as Inverse ARP (see [Ref14]) will allow
  autodiscovery of OSPF neighbors even though broadcast support is not
  available.

2.1.2.  An example link-state database

  Figure 2 shows a sample map of an Autonomous System.  The rectangle
  labelled H1 indicates a host, which has a SLIP connection to Router
  RT12. Router RT12 is therefore advertising a host route.  Lines
  between routers indicate physical point-to-point networks.  The only
  point-to-point network that has been assigned interface addresses is
  the one joining Routers RT6 and RT10.  Routers RT5 and RT7 have BGP
  connections to other Autonomous Systems.  A set of BGP-learned routes
  have been displayed for both of these routers.

  A cost is associated with the output side of each router interface.
  This cost is configurable by the system administrator.  The lower the
  cost,the more likely the interface is to be used to forward data
  traffic.  Costs are also associated with the externally derived
  routing data (e.g., the BGP-learned routes).

  The directed graph resulting from the map in Figure 2 is depicted in
  Figure 3.  Arcs are labelled with the cost of the corresponding
  router output interface. Arcs having no labelled cost have a cost of
  0.  Note that arcs leading from networks to routers always have cost
  0; they are significant nonetheless.  Note also that the externally
  derived routing data appears on the graph as stubs.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 14]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                                                 **FROM**
               +---+      +---+
               |RT3|      |RT4|              |RT3|RT4|RT5|RT6|
               +---+      +---+        *  --------------------
               I3|    N2    |I4        *  RT3|   | X | X | X |
           +----------------------+    T  RT4| X |   |   | X |
               I5|          |I6        O  RT5| X |   |   | X |
               +---+      +---+        *  RT6| X | X | X |   |
               |RT5|      |RT6|        *   I3| X |   |   |   |
               +---+      +---+            I4|   | X |   |   |
                                           I5|   |   | X |   |
                                           I6|   |   |   | X |


                  Figure 1b: Network map components
                     Point-to-MultiPoint networks

         All routers can communicate directly over N2, except
            routers RT4 and RT5. I3 through I6 indicate IP
                         interface addresses































Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 15]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                +
                | 3+---+                     N12      N14
              N1|--|RT1|\ 1                    \ N13 /
                |  +---+ \                     8\ |8/8
                +         \ ____                 \|/
                           /    \   1+---+8    8+---+6
                          *  N3  *---|RT4|------|RT5|--------+
                           \____/    +---+      +---+        |
                 +         /   |                  |7         |
                 | 3+---+ /    |                  |          |
               N2|--|RT2|/1    |1                 |6         |
                 |  +---+    +---+8            6+---+        |
                 +           |RT3|--------------|RT6|        |
                             +---+              +---+        |
                               |2               Ia|7         |
                               |                  |          |
                          +---------+             |          |
                              N4                  |          |
                                                  |          |
                                                  |          |
                      N11                         |          |
                  +---------+                     |          |
                       |                          |          |    N12
                       |3                         |          |6 2/
                     +---+                        |        +---+/
                     |RT9|                        |        |RT7|---N15
                     +---+                        |        +---+ 9
                       |1                   +     |          |1
                      _|__                  |   Ib|5       __|_
                     /    \      1+----+2   |  3+----+1   /    \
                    *  N9  *------|RT11|----|---|RT10|---*  N6  *
                     \____/       +----+    |   +----+    \____/
                       |                    |                |
                       |1                   +                |1
            +--+   10+----+                N8              +---+
            |H1|-----|RT12|                                |RT8|
            +--+SLIP +----+                                +---+
                       |2                                    |4
                       |                                     |
                  +---------+                            +--------+
                      N10                                    N7

                 Figure 2: A sample Autonomous System








Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 16]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                               **FROM**

                |RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|
                |1 |2 |3 |4 |5 |6 |7 |8 |9 |10|11|12|N3|N6|N8|N9|
             ----- ---------------------------------------------
             RT1|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |  |  |  |
             RT2|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |  |  |  |
             RT3|  |  |  |  |  |6 |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |  |  |  |
             RT4|  |  |  |  |8 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |  |  |  |
             RT5|  |  |  |8 |  |6 |6 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
             RT6|  |  |8 |  |7 |  |  |  |  |5 |  |  |  |  |  |  |
             RT7|  |  |  |  |6 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |  |  |
         *   RT8|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |  |  |
         *   RT9|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |
         T  RT10|  |  |  |  |  |7 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |0 |  |
         O  RT11|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |0 |
         *  RT12|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |
         *    N1|3 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              N2|  |3 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              N3|1 |1 |1 |1 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              N4|  |  |2 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              N6|  |  |  |  |  |  |1 |1 |  |1 |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              N7|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |4 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              N8|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |3 |2 |  |  |  |  |  |
              N9|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |1 |  |1 |1 |  |  |  |  |
             N10|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |2 |  |  |  |  |
             N11|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |3 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
             N12|  |  |  |  |8 |  |2 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
             N13|  |  |  |  |8 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
             N14|  |  |  |  |8 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
             N15|  |  |  |  |  |  |9 |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |
              H1|  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |  |10|  |  |  |  |


                Figure 3: The resulting directed graph

          Networks and routers are represented by vertices.
         An edge of cost X connects Vertex A to Vertex B iff
           the intersection of Column A and Row B is marked
                              with an X.

  The link-state database is pieced together from LSAs generated by the
  routers.  In the associated graphical representation, the
  neighborhood of each router or transit network is represented in a
  single, separate LSA.  Figure 4 shows these LSAs graphically. Router
  RT12 has an interface to two broadcast networks and a SLIP line to a
  host.  Network N6 is a broadcast network with three attached routers.
  The cost of all links from Network N6 to its attached routers is 0.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 17]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Note that the LSA for Network N6 is actually generated by one of the
  network's attached routers: the router that has been elected
  Designated Router for the network.

2.2.  The shortest-path tree

  When no OSPF areas are configured, each router in the Autonomous
  System has an identical link-state database, leading to an identical
  graphical representation.  A router generates its routing table from
  this graph by calculating a tree of shortest paths with the router
  itself as root.  Obviously, the shortest- path tree depends on the
  router doing the calculation.  The shortest-path tree for Router RT6
  in our example is depicted in Figure 5.

  The tree gives the entire path to any destination network or host.
  However, only the next hop to the destination is used in the
  forwarding process.   Note also that the best route to any router has
  also been calculated.  For the processing of external data, we note
  the next hop and distance to any router advertising external routes.
  The resulting routing table for Router RT6 is pictured in Table 2.
  Note that there is a separate route for each end of a numbered
  point-to-point network (in this case, the serial line between Routers
  RT6 and RT10).


                    **FROM**                       **FROM**

                 |RT12|N9|N10|H1|                 |RT9|RT11|RT12|N9|
          *  --------------------          *  ----------------------
          *  RT12|    |  |   |  |          *   RT9|   |    |    |0 |
          T    N9|1   |  |   |  |          T  RT11|   |    |    |0 |
          O   N10|2   |  |   |  |          O  RT12|   |    |    |0 |
          *    H1|10  |  |   |  |          *    N9|   |    |    |  |
          *                                *
               RT12's router-LSA              N9's network-LSA

              Figure 4: Individual link state components

          Networks and routers are represented by vertices.
         An edge of cost X connects Vertex A to Vertex B iff
           the intersection of Column A and Row B is marked
                              with an X.









Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 18]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                               RT6(origin)
                   RT5 o------------o-----------o Ib
                      /|\    6      |\     7
                    8/8|8\          | \
                    /  |  \        6|  \
                   o   |   o        |   \7
                  N12  o  N14       |    \
                      N13        2  |     \
                           N4 o-----o RT3  \
                                   /        \    5
                                 1/     RT10 o-------o Ia
                                 /           |\
                      RT4 o-----o N3        3| \1
                               /|            |  \ N6     RT7
                              / |         N8 o   o---------o
                             /  |            |   |        /|
                        RT2 o   o RT1        |   |      2/ |9
                           /    |            |   |RT8   /  |
                          /3    |3      RT11 o   o     o   o
                         /      |            |   |    N12 N15
                     N2 o       o N1        1|   |4
                                             |   |
                                          N9 o   o N7
                                            /|
                                           / |
                       N11      RT9       /  |RT12
                        o--------o-------o   o--------o H1
                            3                |   10
                                             |2
                                             |
                                             o N10


                Figure 5: The SPF tree for Router RT6

 Edges that are not marked with a cost have a cost of of zero (these
are network-to-router links). Routes to networks N12-N15 are external
            information that is considered in Section 2.3













Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 19]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


          Destination   Next  Hop   Distance
          __________________________________
          N1            RT3         10
          N2            RT3         10
          N3            RT3         7
          N4            RT3         8
          Ib            *           7
          Ia            RT10        12
          N6            RT10        8
          N7            RT10        12
          N8            RT10        10
          N9            RT10        11
          N10           RT10        13
          N11           RT10        14
          H1            RT10        21
          __________________________________
          RT5           RT5         6
          RT7           RT10        8

   Table 2: The portion of Router RT6's routing table listing local
                            destinations.

  Routes to networks belonging to other AS'es (such as N12) appear as
  dashed lines on the shortest path tree in Figure 5.  Use of this
  externally derived routing information is considered in the next
  section.

2.3.  Use of external routing information

  After the tree is created the external routing information is
  examined.  This external routing information may originate from
  another routing protocol such as BGP, or be statically configured
  (static routes).  Default routes can also be included as part of the
  Autonomous System's external routing information.

  External routing information is flooded unaltered throughout the AS.
  In our example, all the routers in the Autonomous System know that
  Router RT7 has two external routes, with metrics 2 and 9.

  OSPF supports two types of external metrics.  Type 1 external metrics
  are expressed in the same units as OSPF interface cost (i.e., in
  terms of the link state metric).  Type 2 external metrics are an
  order of magnitude larger; any Type 2 metric is considered greater
  than the cost of any path internal to the AS.  Use of Type 2 external
  metrics assumes that routing between AS'es is the major cost of
  routing a packet, and eliminates the need for conversion of external
  costs to internal link state metrics.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 20]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  As an example of Type 1 external metric processing, suppose that the
  Routers RT7 and RT5 in Figure 2 are advertising Type 1 external
  metrics.  For each advertised external route, the total cost from
  Router RT6 is calculated as the sum of the external route's
  advertised cost and the distance from Router RT6 to the advertising
  router.  When two routers are advertising the same external
  destination, RT6 picks the advertising router providing the minimum
  total cost. RT6 then sets the next hop to the external destination
  equal to the next hop that would be used when routing packets to the
  chosen advertising router.

  In Figure 2, both Router RT5 and RT7 are advertising an external
  route to destination Network N12.  Router RT7 is preferred since it
  is advertising N12 at a distance of 10 (8+2) to Router RT6, which is
  better than Router RT5's 14 (6+8).  Table 3 shows the entries that
  are added to the routing table when external routes are examined:



                Destination   Next  Hop   Distance
                __________________________________
                N12           RT10        10
                N13           RT5         14
                N14           RT5         14
                N15           RT10        17


         Table 3: The portion of Router RT6's routing table
                    listing external destinations.

  Processing of Type 2 external metrics is simpler.  The AS boundary
  router advertising the smallest external metric is chosen, regardless
  of the internal distance to the AS boundary router.  Suppose in our
  example both Router RT5 and Router RT7 were advertising Type 2
  external routes.  Then all traffic destined for Network N12 would be
  forwarded to Router RT7, since 2 < 8. When several equal-cost Type 2
  routes exist, the internal distance to the advertising routers is
  used to break the tie.

  Both Type 1 and Type 2 external metrics can be present in the AS at
  the same time.  In that event, Type 1 external metrics always take
  precedence.

  This section has assumed that packets destined for external
  destinations are always routed through the advertising AS boundary
  router.  This is not always desirable.  For example, suppose in
  Figure 2 there is an additional router attached to Network N6, called
  Router RTX. Suppose further that RTX does not participate in OSPF



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 21]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  routing, but does exchange BGP information with the AS boundary
  router RT7.  Then, Router RT7 would end up advertising OSPF external
  routes for all destinations that should be routed to RTX.  An extra
  hop will sometimes be introduced if packets for these destinations
  need always be routed first to Router RT7 (the advertising router).

  To deal with this situation, the OSPF protocol allows an AS boundary
  router to specify a "forwarding address" in its AS- external-LSAs. In
  the above example, Router RT7 would specify RTX's IP address as the
  "forwarding address" for all those destinations whose packets should
  be routed directly to RTX.

  The "forwarding address" has one other application.  It enables
  routers in the Autonomous System's interior to function as "route
  servers".  For example, in Figure 2 the router RT6 could become a
  route server, gaining external routing information through a
  combination of static configuration and external routing protocols.
  RT6 would then start advertising itself as an AS boundary router, and
  would originate a collection of OSPF AS-external-LSAs.  In each AS-
  external-LSA, Router RT6 would specify the correct Autonomous System
  exit point to use for the destination through appropriate setting of
  the LSA's "forwarding address" field.

2.4.  Equal-cost multipath

  The above discussion has been simplified by considering only a single
  route to any destination.  In reality, if multiple equal-cost routes
  to a destination exist, they are all discovered and used.  This
  requires no conceptual changes to the algorithm, and its discussion
  is postponed until we consider the tree-building process in more
  detail.

  With equal cost multipath, a router potentially has several available
  next hops towards any given destination.

3.  Splitting the AS into Areas

  OSPF allows collections of contiguous networks and hosts to be
  grouped together.  Such a group, together with the routers having
  interfaces to any one of the included networks, is called an area.
  Each area runs a separate copy of the basic link-state routing
  algorithm. This means that each area has its own link-state database
  and corresponding graph, as explained in the previous section.

  The topology of an area is invisible from the outside of the area.
  Conversely, routers internal to a given area know nothing of the
  detailed topology external to the area.  This isolation of knowledge
  enables the protocol to effect a marked reduction in routing traffic



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 22]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  as compared to treating the entire Autonomous System as a single
  link-state domain.

  With the introduction of areas, it is no longer true that all routers
  in the AS have an identical link-state database.  A router actually
  has a separate link-state database for each area it is connected to.
  (Routers connected to multiple areas are called area border routers).
  Two routers belonging to the same area have, for that area, identical
  area link-state databases.

  Routing in the Autonomous System takes place on two levels, depending
  on whether the source and destination of a packet reside in the same
  area (intra-area routing is used) or different areas (inter-area
  routing is used).  In intra-area routing, the packet is routed solely
  on information obtained within the area; no routing information
  obtained from outside the area can be used.  This protects intra-area
  routing from the injection of bad routing information.  We discuss
  inter-area routing in Section 3.2.

3.1.  The backbone of the Autonomous System

  The OSPF backbone is the special OSPF Area 0 (often written as Area
  0.0.0.0, since OSPF Area ID's are typically formatted as IP
  addresses). The OSPF backbone always contains all area border
  routers. The backbone is responsible for distributing routing
  information between non-backbone areas. The backbone must be
  contiguous. However, it need not be physically contiguous; backbone
  connectivity can be established/maintained through the configuration
  of virtual links.

  Virtual links can be configured between any two backbone routers that
  have an interface to a common non-backbone area.  Virtual links
  belong to the backbone.  The protocol treats two routers joined by a
  virtual link as if they were connected by an unnumbered point-to-
  point backbone network.  On the graph of the backbone, two such
  routers are joined by arcs whose costs are the intra-area distances
  between the two routers.  The routing protocol traffic that flows
  along the virtual link uses intra-area routing only.

3.2.  Inter-area routing

  When routing a packet between two non-backbone areas the backbone is
  used.  The path that the packet will travel can be broken up into
  three contiguous pieces: an intra-area path from the source to an
  area border router, a backbone path between the source and
  destination areas, and then another intra-area path to the
  destination.  The algorithm finds the set of such paths that have the
  smallest cost.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 23]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Looking at this another way, inter-area routing can be pictured as
  forcing a star configuration on the Autonomous System, with the
  backbone as hub and each of the non-backbone areas as spokes.

  The topology of the backbone dictates the backbone paths used between
  areas.  The topology of the backbone can be enhanced by adding
  virtual links.  This gives the system administrator some control over
  the routes taken by inter-area traffic.

  The correct area border router to use as the packet exits the source
  area is chosen in exactly the same way routers advertising external
  routes are chosen.  Each area border router in an area summarizes for
  the area its cost to all networks external to the area.  After the
  SPF tree is calculated for the area, routes to all inter-area
  destinations are calculated by examining the summaries of the area
  border routers.

3.3.  Classification of routers

  Before the introduction of areas, the only OSPF routers having a
  specialized function were those advertising external routing
  information, such as Router RT5 in Figure 2.  When the AS is split
  into OSPF areas, the routers are further divided according to
  function into the following four overlapping categories:


  Internal routers
     A router with all directly connected networks belonging to the
     same area. These routers run a single copy of the basic routing
     algorithm.

  Area border routers
     A router that attaches to multiple areas.  Area border routers run
     multiple copies of the basic algorithm, one copy for each attached
     area. Area border routers condense the topological information of
     their attached areas for distribution to the backbone.  The
     backbone in turn distributes the information to the other areas.

  Backbone routers
     A router that has an interface to the backbone area.  This
     includes all routers that interface to more than one area (i.e.,
     area border routers).  However, backbone routers do not have to be
     area border routers.  Routers with all interfaces connecting to
     the backbone area are supported.







Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 24]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  AS boundary routers
     A router that exchanges routing information with routers belonging
     to other Autonomous Systems.  Such a router advertises AS external
     routing information throughout the Autonomous System.  The paths
     to each AS boundary router are known by every router in the AS.
     This classification is completely independent of the previous
     classifications: AS boundary routers may be internal or area
     border routers, and may or may not participate in the backbone.

3.4.  A sample area configuration

  Figure 6 shows a sample area configuration.  The first area consists
  of networks N1-N4, along with their attached routers RT1-RT4.  The
  second area consists of networks N6-N8, along with their attached
  routers RT7, RT8, RT10 and RT11.  The third area consists of networks
  N9-N11 and Host H1, along with their attached routers RT9, RT11 and
  RT12.  The third area has been configured so that networks N9-N11 and
  Host H1 will all be grouped into a single route, when advertised
  external to the area (see Section 3.5 for more details).

  In Figure 6, Routers RT1, RT2, RT5, RT6, RT8, RT9 and RT12 are
  internal routers.  Routers RT3, RT4, RT7, RT10 and RT11 are area
  border routers.  Finally, as before, Routers RT5 and RT7 are AS
  boundary routers.

  Figure 7 shows the resulting link-state database for the Area 1.  The
  figure completely describes that area's intra-area routing.
























Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 25]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


            ...........................
            .   +                     .
            .   | 3+---+              .      N12      N14
            . N1|--|RT1|\ 1           .        \ N13 /
            .   |  +---+ \            .        8\ |8/8
            .   +         \ ____      .          \|/
            .              /    \   1+---+8    8+---+6
            .             *  N3  *---|RT4|------|RT5|--------+
            .              \____/    +---+      +---+        |
            .    +         /      \   .           |7         |
            .    | 3+---+ /        \  .           |          |
            .  N2|--|RT2|/1        1\ .           |6         |
            .    |  +---+            +---+8    6+---+        |
            .    +                   |RT3|------|RT6|        |
            .                        +---+      +---+        |
            .                      2/ .         Ia|7         |
            .                      /  .           |          |
            .             +---------+ .           |          |
            .Area 1           N4      .           |          |
            ...........................           |          |
         ..........................               |          |
         .            N11         .               |          |
         .        +---------+     .               |          |
         .             |          .               |          |    N12
         .             |3         .             Ib|5         |6 2/
         .           +---+        .             +----+     +---+/
         .           |RT9|        .    .........|RT10|.....|RT7|---N15.
         .           +---+        .    .        +----+     +---+ 9    .
         .             |1         .    .    +  /3    1\      |1       .
         .            _|__        .    .    | /        \   __|_       .
         .           /    \      1+----+2   |/          \ /    \      .
         .          *  N9  *------|RT11|----|            *  N6  *     .
         .           \____/       +----+    |             \____/      .
         .             |          .    .    |                |        .
         .             |1         .    .    +                |1       .
         .  +--+   10+----+       .    .   N8              +---+      .
         .  |H1|-----|RT12|       .    .                   |RT8|      .
         .  +--+SLIP +----+       .    .                   +---+      .
         .             |2         .    .                     |4       .
         .             |          .    .                     |        .
         .        +---------+     .    .                 +--------+   .
         .            N10         .    .                     N7       .
         .                        .    .Area 2                        .
         .Area 3                  .    ................................
         ..........................

              Figure 6: A sample OSPF area configuration




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 26]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  It also shows the complete view of the internet for the two internal
  routers RT1 and RT2.  It is the job of the area border routers, RT3
  and RT4, to advertise into Area 1 the distances to all destinations
  external to the area.  These are indicated in Figure 7 by the dashed
  stub routes.  Also, RT3 and RT4 must advertise into Area 1 the
  location of the AS boundary routers RT5 and RT7.  Finally, AS-
  external-LSAs from RT5 and RT7 are flooded throughout the entire AS,
  and in particular throughout Area 1.  These LSAs are included in Area
  1's database, and yield routes to Networks N12-N15.

  Routers RT3 and RT4 must also summarize Area 1's topology for
  distribution to the backbone.  Their backbone LSAs are shown in Table
  4.  These summaries show which networks are contained in Area 1
  (i.e., Networks N1-N4), and the distance to these networks from the
  routers RT3 and RT4 respectively.

  The link-state database for the backbone is shown in Figure 8.  The
  set of routers pictured are the backbone routers.  Router RT11 is a
  backbone router because it belongs to two areas.  In order to make
  the backbone connected, a virtual link has been configured between
  Routers R10 and R11.

  The area border routers RT3, RT4, RT7, RT10 and RT11 condense the
  routing information of their attached non-backbone areas for
  distribution via the backbone; these are the dashed stubs that appear
  in Figure 8.  Remember that the third area has been configured to
  condense Networks N9-N11 and Host H1 into a single route.  This
  yields a single dashed line for networks N9-N11 and Host H1 in Figure
  8.  Routers RT5 and RT7 are AS boundary routers; their externally
  derived information also appears on the graph in Figure 8 as stubs.


                    Network   RT3 adv.   RT4 adv.
                    _____________________________
                    N1        4          4
                    N2        4          4
                    N3        1          1
                    N4        2          3

             Table 4: Networks advertised to the backbone
                       by Routers RT3 and RT4.










Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 27]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                         |RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|
                         |1 |2 |3 |4 |5 |7 |N3|
                      ----- -------------------
                      RT1|  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |
                      RT2|  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |
                      RT3|  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |
                  *   RT4|  |  |  |  |  |  |0 |
                  *   RT5|  |  |14|8 |  |  |  |
                  T   RT7|  |  |20|14|  |  |  |
                  O    N1|3 |  |  |  |  |  |  |
                  *    N2|  |3 |  |  |  |  |  |
                  *    N3|1 |1 |1 |1 |  |  |  |
                       N4|  |  |2 |  |  |  |  |
                    Ia,Ib|  |  |20|27|  |  |  |
                       N6|  |  |16|15|  |  |  |
                       N7|  |  |20|19|  |  |  |
                       N8|  |  |18|18|  |  |  |
                N9-N11,H1|  |  |29|36|  |  |  |
                      N12|  |  |  |  |8 |2 |  |
                      N13|  |  |  |  |8 |  |  |
                      N14|  |  |  |  |8 |  |  |
                      N15|  |  |  |  |  |9 |  |

                     Figure 7: Area 1's Database.

          Networks and routers are represented by vertices.
         An edge of cost X connects Vertex A to Vertex B iff
           the intersection of Column A and Row B is marked
                              with an X.






















Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 28]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                                                 **FROM**

                           |RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT|RT
                           |3 |4 |5 |6 |7 |10|11|
                        ------------------------
                        RT3|  |  |  |6 |  |  |  |
                        RT4|  |  |8 |  |  |  |  |
                        RT5|  |8 |  |6 |6 |  |  |
                        RT6|8 |  |7 |  |  |5 |  |
                        RT7|  |  |6 |  |  |  |  |
                    *  RT10|  |  |  |7 |  |  |2 |
                    *  RT11|  |  |  |  |  |3 |  |
                    T    N1|4 |4 |  |  |  |  |  |
                    O    N2|4 |4 |  |  |  |  |  |
                    *    N3|1 |1 |  |  |  |  |  |
                    *    N4|2 |3 |  |  |  |  |  |
                         Ia|  |  |  |  |  |5 |  |
                         Ib|  |  |  |7 |  |  |  |
                         N6|  |  |  |  |1 |1 |3 |
                         N7|  |  |  |  |5 |5 |7 |
                         N8|  |  |  |  |4 |3 |2 |
                  N9-N11,H1|  |  |  |  |  |  |11|
                        N12|  |  |8 |  |2 |  |  |
                        N13|  |  |8 |  |  |  |  |
                        N14|  |  |8 |  |  |  |  |
                        N15|  |  |  |  |9 |  |  |

                  Figure 8: The backbone's database.

          Networks and routers are represented by vertices.
         An edge of cost X connects Vertex A to Vertex B iff
           the intersection of Column A and Row B is marked
                              with an X.

  The backbone enables the exchange of summary information between area
  border routers.  Every area border router hears the area summaries
  from all other area border routers.  It then forms a picture of the
  distance to all networks outside of its area by examining the
  collected LSAs, and adding in the backbone distance to each
  advertising router.

  Again using Routers RT3 and RT4 as an example, the procedure goes as
  follows: They first calculate the SPF tree for the backbone.  This
  gives the distances to all other area border routers.  Also noted are
  the distances to networks (Ia and Ib) and AS boundary routers (RT5
  and RT7) that belong to the backbone.  This calculation is shown in
  Table 5.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 29]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Next, by looking at the area summaries from these area border
  routers, RT3 and RT4 can determine the distance to all networks
  outside their area.  These distances are then advertised internally
  to the area by RT3 and RT4.  The advertisements that Router RT3 and
  RT4 will make into Area 1 are shown in Table 6.  Note that Table 6
  assumes that an area range has been configured for the backbone which
  groups Ia and Ib into a single LSA.

  The information imported into Area 1 by Routers RT3 and RT4 enables
  an internal router, such as RT1, to choose an area border router
  intelligently.  Router RT1 would use RT4 for traffic to Network N6,
  RT3 for traffic to Network N10, and would load share between the two
  for traffic to Network N8.

                             dist  from   dist  from
                             RT3          RT4
                  __________________________________
                  to  RT3    *            21
                  to  RT4    22           *
                  to  RT7    20           14
                  to  RT10   15           22
                  to  RT11   18           25
                  __________________________________
                  to  Ia     20           27
                  to  Ib     15           22
                  __________________________________
                  to  RT5    14           8
                  to  RT7    20           14

                Table 5: Backbone distances calculated
                       by Routers RT3 and RT4.


                  Destination   RT3 adv.   RT4 adv.
                  _________________________________
                  Ia,Ib         20         27
                  N6            16         15
                  N7            20         19
                  N8            18         18
                  N9-N11,H1     29         36
                  _________________________________
                  RT5           14         8
                  RT7           20         14

             Table 6: Destinations advertised into Area 1
                       by Routers RT3 and RT4.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 30]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Router RT1 can also determine in this manner the shortest path to the
  AS boundary routers RT5 and RT7.  Then, by looking at RT5 and RT7's
  AS-external-LSAs, Router RT1 can decide between RT5 or RT7 when
  sending to a destination in another Autonomous System (one of the
  networks N12-N15).

  Note that a failure of the line between Routers RT6 and RT10 will
  cause the backbone to become disconnected.  Configuring a virtual
  link between Routers RT7 and RT10 will give the backbone more
  connectivity and more resistance to such failures.

3.5.  IP subnetting support

  OSPF attaches an IP address mask to each advertised route.  The mask
  indicates the range of addresses being described by the particular
  route.  For example, a summary-LSA for the destination 128.185.0.0
  with a mask of 0xffff0000 actually is describing a single route to
  the collection of destinations 128.185.0.0 - 128.185.255.255.
  Similarly, host routes are always advertised with a mask of
  0xffffffff, indicating the presence of only a single destination.

  Including the mask with each advertised destination enables the
  implementation of what is commonly referred to as variable-length
  subnetting.  This means that a single IP class A, B, or C network
  number can be broken up into many subnets of various sizes. For
  example, the network 128.185.0.0 could be broken up into 62
  variable-sized subnets: 15 subnets of size 4K, 15 subnets of size
  256, and 32 subnets of size 8.  Table 7 shows some of the resulting
  network addresses together with their masks.


                 Network address   IP address mask   Subnet size
                 _______________________________________________
                 128.185.16.0      0xfffff000        4K
                 128.185.1.0       0xffffff00        256
                 128.185.0.8       0xfffffff8        8


                  Table 7: Some sample subnet sizes.


  There are many possible ways of dividing up a class A, B, and C
  network into variable sized subnets.  The precise procedure for doing
  so is beyond the scope of this specification.  This specification
  however establishes the following guideline: When an IP packet is
  forwarded, it is always forwarded to the network that is the best
  match for the packet's destination.  Here best match is synonymous
  with the longest or most specific match.  For example, the default



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 31]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  route with destination of 0.0.0.0 and mask 0x00000000 is always a
  match for every IP destination.  Yet it is always less specific than
  any other match.  Subnet masks must be assigned so that the best
  match for any IP destination is unambiguous.

  Attaching an address mask to each route also enables the support of
  IP supernetting. For example, a single physical network segment could
  be assigned the [address,mask] pair [192.9.4.0,0xfffffc00]. The
  segment would then be single IP network, containing addresses from
  the four consecutive class C network numbers 192.9.4.0 through
  192.9.7.0. Such addressing is now becoming commonplace with the
  advent of CIDR (see [Ref10]).

  In order to get better aggregation at area boundaries, area address
  ranges can be employed (see Section C.2 for more details).  Each
  address range is defined as an [address,mask] pair.  Many separate
  networks may then be contained in a single address range, just as a
  subnetted network is composed of many separate subnets.  Area border
  routers then summarize the area contents (for distribution to the
  backbone) by advertising a single route for each address range.  The
  cost of the route is the maximum cost to any of the networks falling
  in the specified range.

  For example, an IP subnetted network might be configured as a single
  OSPF area.  In that case, a single address range could be configured:
  a class A, B, or C network number along with its natural IP mask.
  Inside the area, any number of variable sized subnets could be
  defined.  However, external to the area a single route for the entire
  subnetted network would be distributed, hiding even the fact that the
  network is subnetted at all.  The cost of this route is the maximum
  of the set of costs to the component subnets.

3.6.  Supporting stub areas

  In some Autonomous Systems, the majority of the link-state database
  may consist of AS-external-LSAs.  An OSPF AS-external-LSA is usually
  flooded throughout the entire AS.  However, OSPF allows certain areas
  to be configured as "stub areas".  AS-external-LSAs are not flooded
  into/throughout stub areas; routing to AS external destinations in
  these areas is based on a (per-area) default only.  This reduces the
  link-state database size, and therefore the memory requirements, for
  a stub area's internal routers.

  In order to take advantage of the OSPF stub area support, default
  routing must be used in the stub area.  This is accomplished as
  follows.  One or more of the stub area's area border routers must
  advertise a default route into the stub area via summary-LSAs.  These
  summary defaults are flooded throughout the stub area, but no



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 32]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  further.  (For this reason these defaults pertain only to the
  particular stub area).  These summary default routes will be used for
  any destination that is not explicitly reachable by an intra-area or
  inter-area path (i.e., AS external destinations).

  An area can be configured as a stub when there is a single exit point
  from the area, or when the choice of exit point need not be made on a
  per-external-destination basis.  For example, Area 3 in Figure 6
  could be configured as a stub area, because all external traffic must
  travel though its single area border router RT11.  If Area 3 were
  configured as a stub, Router RT11 would advertise a default route for
  distribution inside Area 3 (in a summary-LSA), instead of flooding
  the AS-external-LSAs for Networks N12-N15 into/throughout the area.

  The OSPF protocol ensures that all routers belonging to an area agree
  on whether the area has been configured as a stub.  This guarantees
  that no confusion will arise in the flooding of AS-external-LSAs.

  There are a couple of restrictions on the use of stub areas.  Virtual
  links cannot be configured through stub areas.  In addition, AS
  boundary routers cannot be placed internal to stub areas.

3.7.  Partitions of areas

  OSPF does not actively attempt to repair area partitions.  When an
  area becomes partitioned, each component simply becomes a separate
  area.  The backbone then performs routing between the new areas.
  Some destinations reachable via intra-area routing before the
  partition will now require inter-area routing.

  However, in order to maintain full routing after the partition, an
  address range must not be split across multiple components of the
  area partition. Also, the backbone itself must not partition.  If it
  does, parts of the Autonomous System will become unreachable.
  Backbone partitions can be repaired by configuring virtual links (see
  Section 15).

  Another way to think about area partitions is to look at the
  Autonomous System graph that was introduced in Section 2.  Area IDs
  can be viewed as colors for the graph's edges.[1] Each edge of the
  graph connects to a network, or is itself a point-to-point network.
  In either case, the edge is colored with the network's Area ID.

  A group of edges, all having the same color, and interconnected by
  vertices, represents an area.  If the topology of the Autonomous
  System is intact, the graph will have several regions of color, each
  color being a distinct Area ID.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 33]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  When the AS topology changes, one of the areas may become
  partitioned.  The graph of the AS will then have multiple regions of
  the same color (Area ID).  The routing in the Autonomous System will
  continue to function as long as these regions of same color are
  connected by the single backbone region.

4.  Functional Summary

  A separate copy of OSPF's basic routing algorithm runs in each area.
  Routers having interfaces to multiple areas run multiple copies of
  the algorithm.  A brief summary of the routing algorithm follows.

  When a router starts, it first initializes the routing protocol data
  structures.  The router then waits for indications from the lower-
  level protocols that its interfaces are functional.

  A router then uses the OSPF's Hello Protocol to acquire neighbors.
  The router sends Hello packets to its neighbors, and in turn receives
  their Hello packets.  On broadcast and point-to-point networks, the
  router dynamically detects its neighboring routers by sending its
  Hello packets to the multicast address AllSPFRouters.  On non-
  broadcast networks, some configuration information may be necessary
  in order to discover neighbors.  On broadcast and NBMA networks the
  Hello Protocol also elects a Designated router for the network.

  The router will attempt to form adjacencies with some of its newly
  acquired neighbors.  Link-state databases are synchronized between
  pairs of adjacent routers. On broadcast and NBMA networks, the
  Designated Router determines which routers should become adjacent.

  Adjacencies control the distribution of routing information.  Routing
  updates are sent and received only on adjacencies.

  A router periodically advertises its state, which is also called link
  state.  Link state is also advertised when a router's state changes.
  A router's adjacencies are reflected in the contents of its LSAs.
  This relationship between adjacencies and link state allows the
  protocol to detect dead routers in a timely fashion.

  LSAs are flooded throughout the area.  The flooding algorithm is
  reliable, ensuring that all routers in an area have exactly the same
  link-state database.  This database consists of the collection of
  LSAs originated by each router belonging to the area.  From this
  database each router calculates a shortest-path tree, with itself as
  root.  This shortest-path tree in turn yields a routing table for the
  protocol.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 34]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


4.1.  Inter-area routing

  The previous section described the operation of the protocol within a
  single area.  For intra-area routing, no other routing information is
  pertinent.  In order to be able to route to destinations outside of
  the area, the area border routers inject additional routing
  information into the area.  This additional information is a
  distillation of the rest of the Autonomous System's topology.

  This distillation is accomplished as follows: Each area border router
  is by definition connected to the backbone.  Each area border router
  summarizes the topology of its attached non-backbone areas for
  transmission on the backbone, and hence to all other area border
  routers. An area border router then has complete topological
  information concerning the backbone, and the area summaries from each
  of the other area border routers.  From this information, the router
  calculates paths to all inter-area destinations.  The router then
  advertises these paths into its attached areas.  This enables the
  area's internal routers to pick the best exit router when forwarding
  traffic inter-area destinations.

4.2.  AS external routes

  Routers that have information regarding other Autonomous Systems can
  flood this information throughout the AS.  This external routing
  information is distributed verbatim to every participating router.
  There is one exception: external routing information is not flooded
  into "stub" areas (see Section 3.6).

  To utilize external routing information, the path to all routers
  advertising external information must be known throughout the AS
  (excepting the stub areas).  For that reason, the locations of these
  AS boundary routers are summarized by the (non-stub) area border
  routers.

4.3.  Routing protocol packets

  The OSPF protocol runs directly over IP, using IP protocol 89.  OSPF
  does not provide any explicit fragmentation/reassembly support.  When
  fragmentation is necessary, IP fragmentation/reassembly is used.
  OSPF protocol packets have been designed so that large protocol
  packets can generally be split into several smaller protocol packets.
  This practice is recommended; IP fragmentation should be avoided
  whenever possible.

  Routing protocol packets should always be sent with the IP TOS field
  set to 0.  If at all possible, routing protocol packets should be
  given preference over regular IP data traffic, both when being sent



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 35]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  and received.  As an aid to accomplishing this, OSPF protocol packets
  should have their IP precedence field set to the value Internetwork
  Control (see [Ref5]).

  All OSPF protocol packets share a common protocol header that is
  described in Appendix A.  The OSPF packet types are listed below in
  Table 8.  Their formats are also described in Appendix A.


    Type   Packet  name
          Protocol  function
    __________________________________________________________
    1      Hello                  Discover/maintain  neighbors
    2      Database Description   Summarize database contents
    3      Link State Request     Database download
    4      Link State Update      Database update
    5      Link State Ack         Flooding acknowledgment


                     Table 8: OSPF packet types.

  OSPF's Hello protocol uses Hello packets to discover and maintain
  neighbor relationships.  The Database Description and Link State
  Request packets are used in the forming of adjacencies.  OSPF's
  reliable update mechanism is implemented by the Link State Update and
  Link State Acknowledgment packets.

  Each Link State Update packet carries a set of new link state
  advertisements (LSAs) one hop further away from their point of
  origination.  A single Link State Update packet may contain the LSAs
  of several routers.  Each LSA is tagged with the ID of the
  originating router and a checksum of its link state contents.  Each
  LSA also has a type field; the different types of OSPF LSAs are
  listed below in Table 9.

  OSPF routing packets (with the exception of Hellos) are sent only
  over adjacencies.  This means that all OSPF protocol packets travel a
  single IP hop, except those that are sent over virtual adjacencies.
  The IP source address of an OSPF protocol packet is one end of a
  router adjacency, and the IP destination address is either the other
  end of the adjacency or an IP multicast address.










Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 36]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


       LS     LSA                LSA description
       type   name
       ________________________________________________________
       1      Router-LSAs        Originated by all routers.
                                 This LSA describes
                                 the collected states of the
                                 router's interfaces to an
                                 area. Flooded throughout a
                                 single area only.
       ________________________________________________________
       2      Network-LSAs       Originated for broadcast
                                 and NBMA networks by
                                 the Designated Router. This
                                 LSA contains the
                                 list of routers connected
                                 to the network. Flooded
                                 throughout a single area only.
       ________________________________________________________
       3,4    Summary-LSAs       Originated by area border
                                 routers, and flooded through-
                                 out the LSA's associated
                                 area. Each summary-LSA
                                 describes a route to a
                                 destination outside the area,
                                 yet still inside the AS
                                 (i.e., an inter-area route).
                                 Type 3 summary-LSAs describe
                                 routes to networks. Type 4
                                 summary-LSAs describe
                                 routes to AS boundary routers.
       ________________________________________________________
       5      AS-external-LSAs   Originated by AS boundary
                                 routers, and flooded through-
                                 out the AS. Each
                                 AS-external-LSA describes
                                 a route to a destination in
                                 another Autonomous System.
                                 Default routes for the AS can
                                 also be described by
                                 AS-external-LSAs.

           Table 9: OSPF link state advertisements (LSAs).









Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 37]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


4.4.  Basic implementation requirements

  An implementation of OSPF requires the following pieces of system
  support:

  Timers
     Two different kind of timers are required. The first kind, called
     "single shot timers", fire once and cause a protocol event to be
     processed.  The second kind, called "interval timers", fire at
     continuous intervals.  These are used for the sending of packets
     at regular intervals.  A good example of this is the regular
     broadcast of Hello packets. The granularity of both kinds of
     timers is one second.

     Interval timers should be implemented to avoid drift.  In some
     router implementations, packet processing can affect timer
     execution.  When multiple routers are attached to a single
     network, all doing broadcasts, this can lead to the
     synchronization of routing packets (which should be avoided).  If
     timers cannot be implemented to avoid drift, small random amounts
     should be added to/subtracted from the interval timer at each
     firing.

  IP multicast
     Certain OSPF packets take the form of IP multicast datagrams.
     Support for receiving and sending IP multicast datagrams, along
     with the appropriate lower-level protocol support, is required.
     The IP multicast datagrams used by OSPF never travel more than one
     hop. For this reason, the ability to forward IP multicast
     datagrams is not required.  For information on IP multicast, see
     [Ref7].

  Variable-length subnet support
     The router's IP protocol support must include the ability to
     divide a single IP class A, B, or C network number into many
     subnets of various sizes.  This is commonly called variable-length
     subnetting; see Section 3.5 for details.

  IP supernetting support
     The router's IP protocol support must include the ability to
     aggregate contiguous collections of IP class A, B, and C networks
     into larger quantities called supernets.  Supernetting has been
     proposed as one way to improve the scaling of IP routing in the
     worldwide Internet. For more information on IP supernetting, see
     [Ref10].






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 38]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Lower-level protocol support
     The lower level protocols referred to here are the network access
     protocols, such as the Ethernet data link layer.  Indications must
     be passed from these protocols to OSPF as the network interface
     goes up and down.  For example, on an ethernet it would be
     valuable to know when the ethernet transceiver cable becomes
     unplugged.

  Non-broadcast lower-level protocol support
     On non-broadcast networks, the OSPF Hello Protocol can be aided by
     providing an indication when an attempt is made to send a packet
     to a dead or non-existent router.  For example, on an X.25 PDN a
     dead neighboring router may be indicated by the reception of a
     X.25 clear with an appropriate cause and diagnostic, and this
     information would be passed to OSPF.

  List manipulation primitives
     Much of the OSPF functionality is described in terms of its
     operation on lists of LSAs.  For example, the collection of LSAs
     that will be retransmitted to an adjacent router until
     acknowledged are described as a list.  Any particular LSA may be
     on many such lists.  An OSPF implementation needs to be able to
     manipulate these lists, adding and deleting constituent LSAs as
     necessary.

  Tasking support
     Certain procedures described in this specification invoke other
     procedures.  At times, these other procedures should be executed
     in-line, that is, before the current procedure is finished.  This
     is indicated in the text by instructions to execute a procedure.
     At other times, the other procedures are to be executed only when
     the current procedure has finished.  This is indicated by
     instructions to schedule a task.

4.5.  Optional OSPF capabilities

  The OSPF protocol defines several optional capabilities.  A router
  indicates the optional capabilities that it supports in its OSPF
  Hello packets, Database Description packets and in its LSAs.  This
  enables routers supporting a mix of optional capabilities to coexist
  in a single Autonomous System.

  Some capabilities must be supported by all routers attached to a
  specific area.  In this case, a router will not accept a neighbor's
  Hello Packet unless there is a match in reported capabilities (i.e.,
  a capability mismatch prevents a neighbor relationship from forming).
  An example of this is the ExternalRoutingCapability (see below).




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 39]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Other capabilities can be negotiated during the Database Exchange
  process.  This is accomplished by specifying the optional
  capabilities in Database Description packets.  A capability mismatch
  with a neighbor in this case will result in only a subset of the link
  state database being exchanged between the two neighbors.

  The routing table build process can also be affected by the
  presence/absence of optional capabilities.  For example, since the
  optional capabilities are reported in LSAs, routers incapable of
  certain functions can be avoided when building the shortest path
  tree.

  The OSPF optional capabilities defined in this memo are listed below.
  See Section A.2 for more information.

  ExternalRoutingCapability
     Entire OSPF areas can be configured as "stubs" (see Section 3.6).
     AS-external-LSAs will not be flooded into stub areas.  This
     capability is represented by the E-bit in the OSPF Options field
     (see Section A.2).  In order to ensure consistent configuration of
     stub areas, all routers interfacing to such an area must have the
     E-bit clear in their Hello packets (see Sections 9.5 and 10.5).

5.  Protocol Data Structures

  The OSPF protocol is described herein in terms of its operation on
  various protocol data structures.  The following list comprises the
  top-level OSPF data structures.  Any initialization that needs to be
  done is noted.  OSPF areas, interfaces and neighbors also have
  associated data structures that are described later in this
  specification.

  Router ID
     A 32-bit number that uniquely identifies this router in the AS.
     One possible implementation strategy would be to use the smallest
     IP interface address belonging to the router. If a router's OSPF
     Router ID is changed, the router's OSPF software should be
     restarted before the new Router ID takes effect.  In this case the
     router should flush its self-originated LSAs from the routing
     domain (see Section 14.1) before restarting, or they will persist
     for up to MaxAge minutes.

  Area structures
     Each one of the areas to which the router is connected has its own
     data structure.  This data structure describes the working of the
     basic OSPF algorithm.  Remember that each area runs a separate
     copy of the basic OSPF algorithm.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 40]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Backbone (area) structure
     The OSPF backbone area is responsible for the dissemination of
     inter-area routing information.

  Virtual links configured
     The virtual links configured with this router as one endpoint.  In
     order to have configured virtual links, the router itself must be
     an area border router.  Virtual links are identified by the Router
     ID of the other endpoint -- which is another area border router.
     These two endpoint routers must be attached to a common area,
     called the virtual link's Transit area.  Virtual links are part of
     the backbone, and behave as if they were unnumbered point-to-point
     networks between the two routers.  A virtual link uses the intra-
     area routing of its Transit area to forward packets.  Virtual
     links are brought up and down through the building of the
     shortest-path trees for the Transit area.

  List of external routes
     These are routes to destinations external to the Autonomous
     System, that have been gained either through direct experience
     with another routing protocol (such as BGP), or through
     configuration information, or through a combination of the two
     (e.g., dynamic external information to be advertised by OSPF with
     configured metric). Any router having these external routes is
     called an AS boundary router.  These routes are advertised by the
     router into the OSPF routing domain via AS-external-LSAs.

  List of AS-external-LSAs
     Part of the link-state database.  These have originated from the
     AS boundary routers.  They comprise routes to destinations
     external to the Autonomous System.  Note that, if the router is
     itself an AS boundary router, some of these AS-external-LSAs have
     been self-originated.

  The routing table
     Derived from the link-state database.  Each entry in the routing
     table is indexed by a destination, and contains the destination's
     cost and a set of paths to use in forwarding packets to the
     destination. A path is described by its type and next hop.  For
     more information, see Section 11.











Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 41]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Figure 9 shows the collection of data structures present in a typical
  router.  The router pictured is RT10, from the map in Figure 6.  Note
  that Router RT10 has a virtual link configured to Router RT11, with
  Area 2 as the link's Transit area.  This is indicated by the dashed
  line in Figure 9.  When the virtual link becomes active, through the
  building of the shortest path tree for Area 2, it becomes an
  interface to the backbone (see the two backbone interfaces depicted
  in Figure 9).


                             +----+
                             |RT10|------+
                             +----+       \+-------------+
                            /      \       |Routing Table|
                           /        \      +-------------+
                          /          \
             +------+    /            \    +--------+
             |Area 2|---+              +---|Backbone|
             +------+***********+          +--------+
            /        \           *        /          \
           /          \           *      /            \
      +---------+  +---------+    +------------+       +------------+
      |Interface|  |Interface|    |Virtual Link|       |Interface Ib|
      |  to N6  |  |  to N8  |    |   to RT11  |       +------------+
      +---------+  +---------+    +------------+             |
          /  \           |               |                   |
         /    \          |               |                   |
  +--------+ +--------+  |        +-------------+      +------------+
  |Neighbor| |Neighbor|  |        |Neighbor RT11|      |Neighbor RT6|
  |  RT8   | |  RT7   |  |        +-------------+      +------------+
  +--------+ +--------+  |
                         |
                    +-------------+
                    |Neighbor RT11|
                    +-------------+


               Figure 9: Router RT10's Data structures

6.  The Area Data Structure

  The area data structure contains all the information used to run the
  basic OSPF routing algorithm. Each area maintains its own link-state
  database. A network belongs to a single area, and a router interface
  connects to a single area. Each router adjacency also belongs to a
  single area.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 42]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The OSPF backbone is the special OSPF area responsible for
  disseminating inter-area routing information.

  The area link-state database consists of the collection of router-
  LSAs, network-LSAs and summary-LSAs that have originated from the
  area's routers.  This information is flooded throughout a single area
  only. The list of AS-external-LSAs (see Section 5) is also considered
  to be part of each area's link-state database.

  Area ID
     A 32-bit number identifying the area. The Area ID of 0.0.0.0 is
     reserved for the backbone.

  List of area address ranges
     In order to aggregate routing information at area boundaries, area
     address ranges can be employed. Each address range is specified by
     an [address,mask] pair and a status indication of either Advertise
     or DoNotAdvertise (see Section 12.4.3).

  Associated router interfaces
     This router's interfaces connecting to the area.  A router
     interface belongs to one and only one area (or the backbone).  For
     the backbone area this list includes all the virtual links.  A
     virtual link is identified by the Router ID of its other endpoint;
     its cost is the cost of the shortest intra-area path through the
     Transit area that exists between the two routers.

  List of router-LSAs
     A router-LSA is generated by each router in the area.  It
     describes the state of the router's interfaces to the area.

  List of network-LSAs
     One network-LSA is generated for each transit broadcast and NBMA
     network in the area.  A network-LSA describes the set of routers
     currently connected to the network.

  List of summary-LSAs
     Summary-LSAs originate from the area's area border routers.  They
     describe routes to destinations internal to the Autonomous System,
     yet external to the area (i.e., inter-area destinations).

  Shortest-path tree
     The shortest-path tree for the area, with this router itself as
     root.  Derived from the collected router-LSAs and network-LSAs by
     the Dijkstra algorithm (see Section 16.1).






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 43]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  TransitCapability
     This parameter indicates whether the area can carry data traffic
     that neither originates nor terminates in the area itself. This
     parameter is calculated when the area's shortest-path tree is
     built (see Section 16.1, where TransitCapability is set to TRUE if
     and only if there are one or more fully adjacent virtual links
     using the area as Transit area), and is used as an input to a
     subsequent step of the routing table build process (see Section
     16.3). When an area's TransitCapability is set to TRUE, the area
     is said to be a "transit area".

  ExternalRoutingCapability
     Whether AS-external-LSAs will be flooded into/throughout the area.
     This is a configurable parameter.  If AS-external-LSAs are
     excluded from the area, the area is called a "stub". Within stub
     areas, routing to AS external destinations will be based solely on
     a default summary route.  The backbone cannot be configured as a
     stub area.  Also, virtual links cannot be configured through stub
     areas.  For more information, see Section 3.6.

  StubDefaultCost
     If the area has been configured as a stub area, and the router
     itself is an area border router, then the StubDefaultCost
     indicates the cost of the default summary-LSA that the router
     should advertise into the area. See Section 12.4.3 for more
     information.

  Unless otherwise specified, the remaining sections of this document
  refer to the operation of the OSPF protocol within a single area.

7.  Bringing Up Adjacencies

  OSPF creates adjacencies between neighboring routers for the purpose
  of exchanging routing information. Not every two neighboring routers
  will become adjacent.  This section covers the generalities involved
  in creating adjacencies.  For further details consult Section 10.

7.1.  The Hello Protocol

  The Hello Protocol is responsible for establishing and maintaining
  neighbor relationships.  It also ensures that communication between
  neighbors is bidirectional.  Hello packets are sent periodically out
  all router interfaces.  Bidirectional communication is indicated when
  the router sees itself listed in the neighbor's Hello Packet.  On
  broadcast and NBMA networks, the Hello Protocol elects a Designated
  Router for the network.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 44]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The Hello Protocol works differently on broadcast networks, NBMA
  networks and Point-to-MultiPoint networks.  On broadcast networks,
  each router advertises itself by periodically multicasting Hello
  Packets.  This allows neighbors to be discovered dynamically.  These
  Hello Packets contain the router's view of the Designated Router's
  identity, and the list of routers whose Hello Packets have been seen
  recently.

  On NBMA networks some configuration information may be necessary for
  the operation of the Hello Protocol.  Each router that may
  potentially become Designated Router has a list of all other routers
  attached to the network.  A router, having Designated Router
  potential, sends Hello Packets to all other potential Designated
  Routers when its interface to the NBMA network first becomes
  operational.  This is an attempt to find the Designated Router for
  the network.  If the router itself is elected Designated Router, it
  begins sending Hello Packets to all other routers attached to the
  network.

  On Point-to-MultiPoint networks, a router sends Hello Packets to all
  neighbors with which it can communicate directly. These neighbors may
  be discovered dynamically through a protocol such as Inverse ARP (see
  [Ref14]), or they may be configured.

  After a neighbor has been discovered, bidirectional communication
  ensured, and (if on a broadcast or NBMA network) a Designated Router
  elected, a decision is made regarding whether or not an adjacency
  should be formed with the neighbor (see Section 10.4). If an
  adjacency is to be formed, the first step is to synchronize the
  neighbors' link-state databases.  This is covered in the next
  section.

7.2.  The Synchronization of Databases

  In a link-state routing algorithm, it is very important for all
  routers' link-state databases to stay synchronized.  OSPF simplifies
  this by requiring only adjacent routers to remain synchronized.  The
  synchronization process begins as soon as the routers attempt to
  bring up the adjacency.  Each router describes its database by
  sending a sequence of Database Description packets to its neighbor.
  Each Database Description Packet describes a set of LSAs belonging to
  the router's database.  When the neighbor sees an LSA that is more
  recent than its own database copy, it makes a note that this newer
  LSA should be requested.

  This sending and receiving of Database Description packets is called
  the "Database Exchange Process".  During this process, the two
  routers form a master/slave relationship.  Each Database Description



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 45]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Packet has a sequence number.  Database Description Packets sent by
  the master (polls) are acknowledged by the slave through echoing of
  the sequence number.  Both polls and their responses contain
  summaries of link state data.  The master is the only one allowed to
  retransmit Database Description Packets.  It does so only at fixed
  intervals, the length of which is the configured per-interface
  constant RxmtInterval.

  Each Database Description contains an indication that there are more
  packets to follow --- the M-bit.  The Database Exchange Process is
  over when a router has received and sent Database Description Packets
  with the M-bit off.

  During and after the Database Exchange Process, each router has a
  list of those LSAs for which the neighbor has more up-to-date
  instances.  These LSAs are requested in Link State Request Packets.
  Link State Request packets that are not satisfied are retransmitted
  at fixed intervals of time RxmtInterval.  When the Database
  Description Process has completed and all Link State Requests have
  been satisfied, the databases are deemed synchronized and the routers
  are marked fully adjacent.  At this time the adjacency is fully
  functional and is advertised in the two routers' router-LSAs.

  The adjacency is used by the flooding procedure as soon as the
  Database Exchange Process begins.  This simplifies database
  synchronization, and guarantees that it finishes in a predictable
  period of time.

7.3.  The Designated Router

  Every broadcast and NBMA network has a Designated Router.  The
  Designated Router performs two main functions for the routing
  protocol:

  o   The Designated Router originates a network-LSA on behalf of
      the network.  This LSA lists the set of routers (including
      the Designated Router itself) currently attached to the
      network.  The Link State ID for this LSA (see Section
      12.1.4) is the IP interface address of the Designated
      Router.  The IP network number can then be obtained by using
      the network's subnet/network mask.

  o   The Designated Router becomes adjacent to all other routers
      on the network.  Since the link state databases are
      synchronized across adjacencies (through adjacency bring-up
      and then the flooding procedure), the Designated Router
      plays a central part in the synchronization process.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 46]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The Designated Router is elected by the Hello Protocol.  A router's
  Hello Packet contains its Router Priority, which is configurable on a
  per-interface basis.  In general, when a router's interface to a
  network first becomes functional, it checks to see whether there is
  currently a Designated Router for the network.  If there is, it
  accepts that Designated Router, regardless of its Router Priority.
  (This makes it harder to predict the identity of the Designated
  Router, but ensures that the Designated Router changes less often.
  See below.)  Otherwise, the router itself becomes Designated Router
  if it has the highest Router Priority on the network.  A more
  detailed (and more accurate) description of Designated Router
  election is presented in Section 9.4.

  The Designated Router is the endpoint of many adjacencies.  In order
  to optimize the flooding procedure on broadcast networks, the
  Designated Router multicasts its Link State Update Packets to the
  address AllSPFRouters, rather than sending separate packets over each
  adjacency.

  Section 2 of this document discusses the directed graph
  representation of an area.  Router nodes are labelled with their
  Router ID.  Transit network nodes are actually labelled with the IP
  address of their Designated Router.  It follows that when the
  Designated Router changes, it appears as if the network node on the
  graph is replaced by an entirely new node.  This will cause the
  network and all its attached routers to originate new LSAs.  Until
  the link-state databases again converge, some temporary loss of
  connectivity may result.  This may result in ICMP unreachable
  messages being sent in response to data traffic.  For that reason,
  the Designated Router should change only infrequently.  Router
  Priorities should be configured so that the most dependable router on
  a network eventually becomes Designated Router.

7.4.  The Backup Designated Router

  In order to make the transition to a new Designated Router smoother,
  there is a Backup Designated Router for each broadcast and NBMA
  network.  The Backup Designated Router is also adjacent to all
  routers on the network, and becomes Designated Router when the
  previous Designated Router fails.  If there were no Backup Designated
  Router, when a new Designated Router became necessary, new
  adjacencies would have to be formed between the new Designated Router
  and all other routers attached to the network.  Part of the adjacency
  forming process is the synchronizing of link-state databases, which
  can potentially take quite a long time.  During this time, the
  network would not be available for transit data traffic.  The Backup
  Designated obviates the need to form these adjacencies, since they
  already exist.  This means the period of disruption in transit



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 47]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  traffic lasts only as long as it takes to flood the new LSAs (which
  announce the new Designated Router).

  The Backup Designated Router does not generate a network-LSA for the
  network.  (If it did, the transition to a new Designated Router would
  be even faster.  However, this is a tradeoff between database size
  and speed of convergence when the Designated Router disappears.)

  The Backup Designated Router is also elected by the Hello Protocol.
  Each Hello Packet has a field that specifies the Backup Designated
  Router for the network.

  In some steps of the flooding procedure, the Backup Designated Router
  plays a passive role, letting the Designated Router do more of the
  work.  This cuts down on the amount of local routing traffic.  See
  Section 13.3 for more information.

7.5.  The graph of adjacencies

  An adjacency is bound to the network that the two routers have in
  common.  If two routers have multiple networks in common, they may
  have multiple adjacencies between them.

  One can picture the collection of adjacencies on a network as forming
  an undirected graph.  The vertices consist of routers, with an edge
  joining two routers if they are adjacent.  The graph of adjacencies
  describes the flow of routing protocol packets, and in particular
  Link State Update Packets, through the Autonomous System.

  Two graphs are possible, depending on whether a Designated Router is
  elected for the network.  On physical point-to-point networks,
  Point-to-MultiPoint networks and virtual links, neighboring routers
  become adjacent whenever they can communicate directly.  In contrast,
  on broadcast and NBMA networks only the Designated Router and the
  Backup Designated Router become adjacent to all other routers
  attached to the network.

  These graphs are shown in Figure 10.  It is assumed that Router RT7
  has become the Designated Router, and Router RT3 the Backup
  Designated Router, for the Network N2.  The Backup Designated Router
  performs a lesser function during the flooding procedure than the
  Designated Router (see Section 13.3).  This is the reason for the
  dashed lines connecting the Backup Designated Router RT3.








Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 48]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


         +---+            +---+
         |RT1|------------|RT2|            o---------------o
         +---+    N1      +---+           RT1             RT2



                                                RT7
                                                 o---------+
           +---+   +---+   +---+                /|\        |
           |RT7|   |RT3|   |RT4|               / | \       |
           +---+   +---+   +---+              /  |  \      |
             |       |       |               /   |   \     |
        +-----------------------+        RT5o RT6o    oRT4 |
                 |       |     N2            *   *   *     |
               +---+   +---+                  *  *  *      |
               |RT5|   |RT6|                   * * *       |
               +---+   +---+                    ***        |
                                                 o---------+
                                                RT3


                 Figure 10: The graph of adjacencies

8.  Protocol Packet Processing

  This section discusses the general processing of OSPF routing
  protocol packets.  It is very important that the router link-state
  databases remain synchronized.  For this reason, routing protocol
  packets should get preferential treatment over ordinary data packets,
  both in sending and receiving.

  Routing protocol packets are sent along adjacencies only (with the
  exception of Hello packets, which are used to discover the
  adjacencies).  This means that all routing protocol packets travel a
  single IP hop, except those sent over virtual links.

  All routing protocol packets begin with a standard header. The
  sections below provide details on how to fill in and verify this
  standard header.  Then, for each packet type, the section giving more
  details on that particular packet type's processing is listed.

8.1.  Sending protocol packets

  When a router sends a routing protocol packet, it fills in the fields
  of the standard OSPF packet header as follows.  For more details on
  the header format consult Section A.3.1:





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 49]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Version #
     Set to 2, the version number of the protocol as documented in this
     specification.

  Packet type
     The type of OSPF packet, such as Link state Update or Hello
     Packet.

  Packet length
     The length of the entire OSPF packet in bytes, including the
     standard OSPF packet header.

  Router ID
     The identity of the router itself (who is originating the packet).

  Area ID
     The OSPF area that the packet is being sent into.

  Checksum
     The standard IP 16-bit one's complement checksum of the entire
     OSPF packet, excluding the 64-bit authentication field.  This
     checksum is calculated as part of the appropriate authentication
     procedure; for some OSPF authentication types, the checksum
     calculation is omitted.  See Section D.4 for details.

  AuType and Authentication
     Each OSPF packet exchange is authenticated.  Authentication types
     are assigned by the protocol and are documented in Appendix D.  A
     different authentication procedure can be used for each IP
     network/subnet.  Autype indicates the type of authentication
     procedure in use.  The 64-bit authentication field is then for use
     by the chosen authentication procedure.  This procedure should be
     the last called when forming the packet to be sent.  See Section
     D.4 for details.

















Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 50]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The IP destination address for the packet is selected as follows.  On
  physical point-to-point networks, the IP destination is always set to
  the address AllSPFRouters.  On all other network types (including
  virtual links), the majority of OSPF packets are sent as unicasts,
  i.e., sent directly to the other end of the adjacency.  In this case,
  the IP destination is just the Neighbor IP address associated with
  the other end of the adjacency (see Section 10).  The only packets
  not sent as unicasts are on broadcast networks; on these networks
  Hello packets are sent to the multicast destination AllSPFRouters,
  the Designated Router and its Backup send both Link State Update
  Packets and Link State Acknowledgment Packets to the multicast
  address AllSPFRouters, while all other routers send both their Link
  State Update and Link State Acknowledgment Packets to the multicast
  address AllDRouters.

  Retransmissions of Link State Update packets are ALWAYS sent as
  unicasts.

  The IP source address should be set to the IP address of the sending
  interface.  Interfaces to unnumbered point-to-point networks have no
  associated IP address.  On these interfaces, the IP source should be
  set to any of the other IP addresses belonging to the router.  For
  this reason, there must be at least one IP address assigned to the
  router.[2] Note that, for most purposes, virtual links act precisely
  the same as unnumbered point-to-point networks.  However, each
  virtual link does have an IP interface address (discovered during the
  routing table build process) which is used as the IP source when
  sending packets over the virtual link.

  For more information on the format of specific OSPF packet types,
  consult the sections listed in Table 10.


            Type   Packet name            detailed section (transmit)
            _________________________________________________________
            1      Hello                  Section  9.5
            2      Database description   Section 10.8
            3      Link state request     Section 10.9
            4      Link state update      Section 13.3
            5      Link state ack         Section 13.5

   Table 10: Sections describing OSPF protocol packet transmission.

8.2.  Receiving protocol packets

  Whenever a protocol packet is received by the router it is marked
  with the interface it was received on.  For routers that have virtual
  links configured, it may not be immediately obvious which interface



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 51]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  to associate the packet with.  For example, consider the Router RT11
  depicted in Figure 6.  If RT11 receives an OSPF protocol packet on
  its interface to Network N8, it may want to associate the packet with
  the interface to Area 2, or with the virtual link to Router RT10
  (which is part of the backbone).  In the following, we assume that
  the packet is initially associated with the non-virtual  link.[3]

  In order for the packet to be accepted at the IP level, it must pass
  a number of tests, even before the packet is passed to OSPF for
  processing:

  o   The IP checksum must be correct.

  o   The packet's IP destination address must be the IP address
      of the receiving interface, or one of the IP multicast
      addresses AllSPFRouters or AllDRouters.

  o   The IP protocol specified must be OSPF (89).

  o   Locally originated packets should not be passed on to OSPF.
      That is, the source IP address should be examined to make
      sure this is not a multicast packet that the router itself
      generated.

  Next, the OSPF packet header is verified.  The fields specified
  in the header must match those configured for the receiving
  interface.  If they do not, the packet should be discarded:


  o   The version number field must specify protocol version 2.

  o   The Area ID found in the OSPF header must be verified.  If
      both of the following cases fail, the packet should be
      discarded.  The Area ID specified in the header must either:

      (1) Match the Area ID of the receiving interface.  In this
          case, the packet has been sent over a single hop.
          Therefore, the packet's IP source address is required to
          be on the same network as the receiving interface.  This
          can be verified by comparing the packet's IP source
          address to the interface's IP address, after masking
          both addresses with the interface mask.  This comparison
          should not be performed on point-to-point networks. On
          point-to-point networks, the interface addresses of each
          end of the link are assigned independently, if they are
          assigned at all.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 52]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      (2) Indicate the backbone.  In this case, the packet has
          been sent over a virtual link.  The receiving router
          must be an area border router, and the Router ID
          specified in the packet (the source router) must be the
          other end of a configured virtual link.  The receiving
          interface must also attach to the virtual link's
          configured Transit area.  If all of these checks
          succeed, the packet is accepted and is from now on
          associated with the virtual link (and the backbone
          area).

  o   Packets whose IP destination is AllDRouters should only be
      accepted if the state of the receiving interface is DR or
      Backup (see Section 9.1).

  o   The AuType specified in the packet must match the AuType
      specified for the associated area.

  o   The packet must be authenticated.  The authentication
      procedure is indicated by the setting of AuType (see
      Appendix D).  The authentication procedure may use one or
      more Authentication keys, which can be configured on a per-
      interface basis.  The authentication procedure may also
      verify the checksum field in the OSPF packet header (which,
      when used, is set to the standard IP 16-bit one's complement
      checksum of the OSPF packet's contents after excluding the
      64-bit authentication field).  If the authentication
      procedure fails, the packet should be discarded.

  If the packet type is Hello, it should then be further processed by
  the Hello Protocol (see Section 10.5).  All other packet types are
  sent/received only on adjacencies.  This means that the packet must
  have been sent by one of the router's active neighbors.  If the
  receiving interface connects to a broadcast network, Point-to-
  MultiPoint network or NBMA network the sender is identified by the IP
  source address found in the packet's IP header.  If the receiving
  interface connects to a point-to-point network or a virtual link, the
  sender is identified by the Router ID (source router) found in the
  packet's OSPF header.  The data structure associated with the
  receiving interface contains the list of active neighbors.  Packets
  not matching any active neighbor are discarded.

  At this point all received protocol packets are associated with an
  active neighbor.  For the further input processing of specific packet
  types, consult the sections listed in Table 11.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 53]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


     Type   Packet name            detailed section (receive)
     ________________________________________________________
     1      Hello                  Section 10.5
     2      Database description   Section 10.6
     3      Link state request     Section 10.7
     4      Link state update      Section 13
     5      Link state ack         Section 13.7

    Table 11: Sections describing OSPF protocol packet reception.

9.  The Interface Data Structure

  An OSPF interface is the connection between a router and a network.
  We assume a single OSPF interface to each attached network/subnet,
  although supporting multiple interfaces on a single network is
  considered in Appendix F. Each interface structure has at most one IP
  interface address.

  An OSPF interface can be considered to belong to the area that
  contains the attached network.  All routing protocol packets
  originated by the router over this interface are labelled with the
  interface's Area ID.  One or more router adjacencies may develop over
  an interface. A router's LSAs reflect the state of its interfaces and
  their associated adjacencies.

  The following data items are associated with an interface. Note that
  a number of these items are actually configuration for the attached
  network; such items must be the same for all routers connected to the
  network.

  Type
     The OSPF interface type is either point-to-point, broadcast, NBMA,
     Point-to-MultiPoint or virtual link.

  State
     The functional level of an interface.  State determines whether or
     not full adjacencies are allowed to form over the interface.
     State is also reflected in the router's LSAs.

  IP interface address
     The IP address associated with the interface.  This appears as the
     IP source address in all routing protocol packets originated over
     this interface.  Interfaces to unnumbered point-to-point networks
     do not have an associated IP address.

  IP interface mask
     Also referred to as the subnet mask, this indicates the portion of
     the IP interface address that identifies the attached network.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 54]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


     Masking the IP interface address with the IP interface mask yields
     the IP network number of the attached network.  On point-to-point
     networks and virtual links, the IP interface mask is not defined.
     On these networks, the link itself is not assigned an IP network
     number, and so the addresses of each side of the link are assigned
     independently, if they are assigned at all.

  Area ID
     The Area ID of the area to which the attached network belongs.
     All routing protocol packets originating from the interface are
     labelled with this Area ID.

  HelloInterval
     The length of time, in seconds, between the Hello packets that the
     router sends on the interface.  Advertised in Hello packets sent
     out this interface.

  RouterDeadInterval
     The number of seconds before the router's neighbors will declare
     it down, when they stop hearing the router's Hello Packets.
     Advertised in Hello packets sent out this interface.

  InfTransDelay
     The estimated number of seconds it takes to transmit a Link State
     Update Packet over this interface.  LSAs contained in the Link
     State Update packet will have their age incremented by this amount
     before transmission.  This value should take into account
     transmission and propagation delays; it must be greater than zero.

  Router Priority
     An 8-bit unsigned integer.  When two routers attached to a network
     both attempt to become Designated Router, the one with the highest
     Router Priority takes precedence.  A router whose Router Priority
     is set to 0 is ineligible to become Designated Router on the
     attached network.  Advertised in Hello packets sent out this
     interface.

  Hello Timer
     An interval timer that causes the interface to send a Hello
     packet.  This timer fires every HelloInterval seconds.  Note that
     on non-broadcast networks a separate Hello packet is sent to each
     qualified neighbor.

  Wait Timer
     A single shot timer that causes the interface to exit the Waiting
     state, and as a consequence select a Designated Router on the
     network.  The length of the timer is RouterDeadInterval seconds.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 55]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  List of neighboring routers
     The other routers attached to this network.  This list is formed
     by the Hello Protocol.  Adjacencies will be formed to some of
     these neighbors.  The set of adjacent neighbors can be determined
     by an examination of all of the neighbors' states.

  Designated Router
     The Designated Router selected for the attached network.  The
     Designated Router is selected on all broadcast and NBMA networks
     by the Hello Protocol.  Two pieces of identification are kept for
     the Designated Router: its Router ID and its IP interface address
     on the network.  The Designated Router advertises link state for
     the network; this network-LSA is labelled with the Designated
     Router's IP address.  The Designated Router is initialized to
     0.0.0.0, which indicates the lack of a Designated Router.

  Backup Designated Router
     The Backup Designated Router is also selected on all broadcast and
     NBMA networks by the Hello Protocol.  All routers on the attached
     network become adjacent to both the Designated Router and the
     Backup Designated Router.  The Backup Designated Router becomes
     Designated Router when the current Designated Router fails. The
     Backup Designated Router is initialized to 0.0.0.0, indicating the
     lack of a Backup Designated Router.

  Interface output cost(s)
     The cost of sending a data packet on the interface, expressed in
     the link state metric.  This is advertised as the link cost for
     this interface in the router-LSA. The cost of an interface must be
     greater than zero.

  RxmtInterval
     The number of seconds between LSA retransmissions, for adjacencies
     belonging to this interface.  Also used when retransmitting
     Database Description and Link State Request Packets.

  AuType
     The type of authentication used on the attached network/subnet.
     Authentication types are defined in Appendix D.  All OSPF packet
     exchanges are authenticated.  Different authentication schemes may
     be used on different networks/subnets.










Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 56]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Authentication key
     This configured data allows the authentication procedure to
     generate and/or verify OSPF protocol packets.  The Authentication
     key can be configured on a per-interface basis.  For example, if
     the AuType indicates simple password, the Authentication key would
     be a 64-bit clear password which is inserted into the OSPF packet
     header. If instead Autype indicates Cryptographic authentication,
     then the Authentication key is a shared secret which enables the
     generation/verification of message digests which are appended to
     the OSPF protocol packets. When Cryptographic authentication is
     used, multiple simultaneous keys are supported in order to achieve
     smooth key transition (see Section D.3).

9.1.  Interface states

  The various states that router interfaces may attain is documented in
  this section.  The states are listed in order of progressing
  functionality.  For example, the inoperative state is listed first,
  followed by a list of intermediate states before the final, fully
  functional state is achieved.  The specification makes use of this
  ordering by sometimes making references such as "those interfaces in
  state greater than X".  Figure 11 shows the graph of interface state
  changes.  The arcs of the graph are labelled with the event causing
  the state change.  These events are documented in Section 9.2.  The
  interface state machine is described in more detail in Section 9.3.

  Down
     This is the initial interface state.  In this state, the lower-
     level protocols have indicated that the interface is unusable.  No
     protocol traffic at all will be sent or received on such a
     interface.  In this state, interface parameters should be set to
     their initial values.



















Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 57]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                                 +----+   UnloopInd   +--------+
                                 |Down|<--------------|Loopback|
                                 +----+               +--------+
                                    |
                                    |InterfaceUp
                         +-------+  |               +--------------+
                         |Waiting|<-+-------------->|Point-to-point|
                         +-------+                  +--------------+
                             |
                    WaitTimer|BackupSeen
                             |
                             |
                             |   NeighborChange
         +------+           +-+<---------------- +-------+
         |Backup|<----------|?|----------------->|DROther|
         +------+---------->+-+<-----+           +-------+
                   Neighbor  |       |
                   Change    |       |Neighbor
                             |       |Change
                             |     +--+
                             +---->|DR|
                                   +--+

                  Figure 11: Interface State changes

            In addition to the state transitions pictured,
          Event InterfaceDown always forces Down State, and
              Event LoopInd always forces Loopback State

     All interface timers should be disabled, and there should be no
     adjacencies associated with the interface.

  Loopback
     In this state, the router's interface to the network is looped
     back.  The interface may be looped back in hardware or software.
     The interface will be unavailable for regular data traffic.
     However, it may still be desirable to gain information on the
     quality of this interface, either through sending ICMP pings to
     the interface or through something like a bit error test.  For
     this reason, IP packets may still be addressed to an interface in
     Loopback state.  To facilitate this, such interfaces are
     advertised in router-LSAs as single host routes, whose destination
     is the IP interface address.[4]








Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 58]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Waiting
     In this state, the router is trying to determine the identity of
     the (Backup) Designated Router for the network.  To do this, the
     router monitors the Hello Packets it receives.  The router is not
     allowed to elect a Backup Designated Router nor a Designated
     Router until it transitions out of Waiting state.  This prevents
     unnecessary changes of (Backup) Designated Router.

  Point-to-point
     In this state, the interface is operational, and connects either
     to a physical point-to-point network or to a virtual link.  Upon
     entering this state, the router attempts to form an adjacency with
     the neighboring router.  Hello Packets are sent to the neighbor
     every HelloInterval seconds.

  DR Other
     The interface is to a broadcast or NBMA network on which another
     router has been selected to be the Designated Router.  In this
     state, the router itself has not been selected Backup Designated
     Router either.  The router forms adjacencies to both the
     Designated Router and the Backup Designated Router (if they
     exist).

  Backup
     In this state, the router itself is the Backup Designated Router
     on the attached network.  It will be promoted to Designated Router
     when the present Designated Router fails.  The router establishes
     adjacencies to all other routers attached to the network.  The
     Backup Designated Router performs slightly different functions
     during the Flooding Procedure, as compared to the Designated
     Router (see Section 13.3).  See Section 7.4 for more details on
     the functions performed by the Backup Designated Router.

  DR  In this state, this router itself is the Designated Router
     on the attached network.  Adjacencies are established to all other
     routers attached to the network.  The router must also originate a
     network-LSA for the network node.  The network-LSA will contain
     links to all routers (including the Designated Router itself)
     attached to the network.  See Section 7.3 for more details on the
     functions performed by the Designated Router.

9.2.  Events causing interface state changes

  State changes can be effected by a number of events.  These events
  are pictured as the labelled arcs in Figure 11.  The label
  definitions are listed below.  For a detailed explanation of the
  effect of these events on OSPF protocol operation, consult Section
  9.3.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 59]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  InterfaceUp
     Lower-level protocols have indicated that the network interface is
     operational.  This enables the interface to transition out of Down
     state.  On virtual links, the interface operational indication is
     actually a result of the shortest path calculation (see Section
     16.7).

  WaitTimer
     The Wait Timer has fired, indicating the end of the waiting period
     that is required before electing a (Backup) Designated Router.

  BackupSeen
     The router has detected the existence or non-existence of a Backup
     Designated Router for the network.  This is done in one of two
     ways.  First, an Hello Packet may be received from a neighbor
     claiming to be itself the Backup Designated Router.
     Alternatively, an Hello Packet may be received from a neighbor
     claiming to be itself the Designated Router, and indicating that
     there is no Backup Designated Router.  In either case there must
     be bidirectional communication with the neighbor, i.e., the router
     must also appear in the neighbor's Hello Packet.  This event
     signals an end to the Waiting state.

  NeighborChange
     There has been a change in the set of bidirectional neighbors
     associated with the interface.  The (Backup) Designated Router
     needs to be recalculated.  The following neighbor changes lead to
     the NeighborChange event. For an explanation of neighbor states,
     see Section 10.1.

      o   Bidirectional communication has been established to a
          neighbor.  In other words, the state of the neighbor has
          transitioned to 2-Way or higher.

      o   There is no longer bidirectional communication with a
          neighbor.  In other words, the state of the neighbor has
          transitioned to Init or lower.

      o   One of the bidirectional neighbors is newly declaring
          itself as either Designated Router or Backup Designated
          Router.  This is detected through examination of that
          neighbor's Hello Packets.

      o   One of the bidirectional neighbors is no longer
          declaring itself as Designated Router, or is no longer
          declaring itself as Backup Designated Router.  This is
          again detected through examination of that neighbor's
          Hello Packets.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 60]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      o   The advertised Router Priority for a bidirectional
          neighbor has changed.  This is again detected through
          examination of that neighbor's Hello Packets.

  LoopInd
     An indication has been received that the interface is now looped
     back to itself.  This indication can be received either from
     network management or from the lower level protocols.

  UnloopInd
     An indication has been received that the interface is no longer
     looped back.  As with the LoopInd event, this indication can be
     received either from network management or from the lower level
     protocols.

  InterfaceDown
     Lower-level protocols indicate that this interface is no longer
     functional. No matter what the current interface state is, the new
     interface state will be Down.

9.3.  The Interface state machine

  A detailed description of the interface state changes follows.  Each
  state change is invoked by an event (Section 9.2).  This event may
  produce different effects, depending on the current state of the
  interface.  For this reason, the state machine below is organized by
  current interface state and received event. Each entry in the state
  machine describes the resulting new interface state and the required
  set of additional actions.

  When an interface's state changes, it may be necessary to originate a
  new router-LSA.  See Section 12.4 for more details.

  Some of the required actions below involve generating events for the
  neighbor state machine.  For example, when an interface becomes
  inoperative, all neighbor connections associated with the interface
  must be destroyed.  For more information on the neighbor state
  machine, see Section 10.3.













Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 61]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   State(s):  Down

      Event:  InterfaceUp

  New state:  Depends upon action routine

     Action:  Start the interval Hello Timer, enabling the
              periodic sending of Hello packets out the interface.
              If the attached network is a physical point-to-point
              network, Point-to-MultiPoint network or virtual
              link, the interface state transitions to Point-to-
              Point.  Else, if the router is not eligible to
              become Designated Router the interface state
              transitions to DR Other.

              Otherwise, the attached network is a broadcast or
              NBMA network and the router is eligible to become
              Designated Router.  In this case, in an attempt to
              discover the attached network's Designated Router
              the interface state is set to Waiting and the single
              shot Wait Timer is started.  Additionally, if the
              network is an NBMA network examine the configured
              list of neighbors for this interface and generate
              the neighbor event Start for each neighbor that is
              also eligible to become Designated Router.

   State(s):  Waiting

      Event:  BackupSeen

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.

     Action:  Calculate the attached network's Backup Designated
              Router and Designated Router, as shown in Section
              9.4.  As a result of this calculation, the new state
              of the interface will be either DR Other, Backup or
              DR.


   State(s):  Waiting

      Event:  WaitTimer

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.







Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 62]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


     Action:  Calculate the attached network's Backup Designated
              Router and Designated Router, as shown in Section
              9.4.  As a result of this calculation, the new state
              of the interface will be either DR Other, Backup or
              DR.


   State(s):  DR Other, Backup or DR

      Event:  NeighborChange

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.

     Action:  Recalculate the attached network's Backup Designated
              Router and Designated Router, as shown in Section
              9.4.  As a result of this calculation, the new state
              of the interface will be either DR Other, Backup or
              DR.


   State(s):  Any State

      Event:  InterfaceDown

  New state:  Down

     Action:  All interface variables are reset, and interface
              timers disabled.  Also, all neighbor connections
              associated with the interface are destroyed.  This
              is done by generating the event KillNbr on all
              associated neighbors (see Section 10.2).


   State(s):  Any State

      Event:  LoopInd

  New state:  Loopback

     Action:  Since this interface is no longer connected to the
              attached network the actions associated with the
              above InterfaceDown event are executed.


   State(s):  Loopback

      Event:  UnloopInd




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 63]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  New state:  Down

     Action:  No actions are necessary.  For example, the
              interface variables have already been reset upon
              entering the Loopback state.  Note that reception of
              an InterfaceUp event is necessary before the
              interface again becomes fully functional.

9.4.  Electing the Designated Router

  This section describes the algorithm used for calculating a network's
  Designated Router and Backup Designated Router.  This algorithm is
  invoked by the Interface state machine.  The initial time a router
  runs the election algorithm for a network, the network's Designated
  Router and Backup Designated Router are initialized to 0.0.0.0.  This
  indicates the lack of both a Designated Router and a Backup
  Designated Router.

  The Designated Router election algorithm proceeds as follows: Call
  the router doing the calculation Router X.  The list of neighbors
  attached to the network and having established bidirectional
  communication with Router X is examined.  This list is precisely the
  collection of Router X's neighbors (on this network) whose state is
  greater than or equal to 2-Way (see Section 10.1).  Router X itself
  is also considered to be on the list.  Discard all routers from the
  list that are ineligible to become Designated Router.  (Routers
  having Router Priority of 0 are ineligible to become Designated
  Router.)  The following steps are then executed, considering only
  those routers that remain on the list:

  (1) Note the current values for the network's Designated Router
      and Backup Designated Router.  This is used later for
      comparison purposes.

  (2) Calculate the new Backup Designated Router for the network
      as follows.  Only those routers on the list that have not
      declared themselves to be Designated Router are eligible to
      become Backup Designated Router.  If one or more of these
      routers have declared themselves Backup Designated Router
      (i.e., they are currently listing themselves as Backup
      Designated Router, but not as Designated Router, in their
      Hello Packets) the one having highest Router Priority is
      declared to be Backup Designated Router.  In case of a tie,
      the one having the highest Router ID is chosen.  If no
      routers have declared themselves Backup Designated Router,






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 64]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      choose the router having highest Router Priority, (again
      excluding those routers who have declared themselves
      Designated Router), and again use the Router ID to break
      ties.

  (3) Calculate the new Designated Router for the network as
      follows.  If one or more of the routers have declared
      themselves Designated Router (i.e., they are currently
      listing themselves as Designated Router in their Hello
      Packets) the one having highest Router Priority is declared
      to be Designated Router.  In case of a tie, the one having
      the highest Router ID is chosen.  If no routers have
      declared themselves Designated Router, assign the Designated
      Router to be the same as the newly elected Backup Designated
      Router.

  (4) If Router X is now newly the Designated Router or newly the
      Backup Designated Router, or is now no longer the Designated
      Router or no longer the Backup Designated Router, repeat
      steps 2 and 3, and then proceed to step 5.  For example, if
      Router X is now the Designated Router, when step 2 is
      repeated X will no longer be eligible for Backup Designated
      Router election.  Among other things, this will ensure that
      no router will declare itself both Backup Designated Router
      and Designated Router.[5]

  (5) As a result of these calculations, the router itself may now
      be Designated Router or Backup Designated Router.  See
      Sections 7.3 and 7.4 for the additional duties this would
      entail.  The router's interface state should be set
      accordingly.  If the router itself is now Designated Router,
      the new interface state is DR.  If the router itself is now
      Backup Designated Router, the new interface state is Backup.
      Otherwise, the new interface state is DR Other.

  (6) If the attached network is an NBMA network, and the router
      itself has just become either Designated Router or Backup
      Designated Router, it must start sending Hello Packets to
      those neighbors that are not eligible to become Designated
      Router (see Section 9.5.1).  This is done by invoking the
      neighbor event Start for each neighbor having a Router
      Priority of 0.

  (7) If the above calculations have caused the identity of either
      the Designated Router or Backup Designated Router to change,
      the set of adjacencies associated with this interface will
      need to be modified.  Some adjacencies may need to be
      formed, and others may need to be broken.  To accomplish



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 65]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      this, invoke the event AdjOK?  on all neighbors whose state
      is at least 2-Way.  This will cause their eligibility for
      adjacency to be reexamined (see Sections 10.3 and 10.4).


  The reason behind the election algorithm's complexity is the desire
  for an orderly transition from Backup Designated Router to Designated
  Router, when the current Designated Router fails.  This orderly
  transition is ensured through the introduction of hysteresis: no new
  Backup Designated Router can be chosen until the old Backup accepts
  its new Designated Router responsibilities.

  The above procedure may elect the same router to be both Designated
  Router and Backup Designated Router, although that router will never
  be the calculating router (Router X) itself.  The elected Designated
  Router may not be the router having the highest Router Priority, nor
  will the Backup Designated Router necessarily have the second highest
  Router Priority.  If Router X is not itself eligible to become
  Designated Router, it is possible that neither a Backup Designated
  Router nor a Designated Router will be selected in the above
  procedure.  Note also that if Router X is the only attached router
  that is eligible to become Designated Router, it will select itself
  as Designated Router and there will be no Backup Designated Router
  for the network.

9.5.  Sending Hello packets

  Hello packets are sent out each functioning router interface.  They
  are used to discover and maintain neighbor relationships.[6] On
  broadcast and NBMA networks, Hello Packets are also used to elect the
  Designated Router and Backup Designated Router.

  The format of an Hello packet is detailed in Section A.3.2.  The
  Hello Packet contains the router's Router Priority (used in choosing
  the Designated Router), and the interval between Hello Packets sent
  out the interface (HelloInterval).  The Hello Packet also indicates
  how often a neighbor must be heard from to remain active
  (RouterDeadInterval).  Both HelloInterval and RouterDeadInterval must
  be the same for all routers attached to a common network.  The Hello
  packet also contains the IP address mask of the attached network
  (Network Mask).  On unnumbered point-to-point networks and on virtual
  links this field should be set to 0.0.0.0.

  The Hello packet's Options field describes the router's optional OSPF
  capabilities.  One optional capability is defined in this
  specification (see Sections 4.5 and A.2).  The E-bit of the Options
  field should be set if and only if the attached area is capable of
  processing AS-external-LSAs (i.e., it is not a stub area). If the E-



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 66]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  bit is set incorrectly the neighboring routers will refuse to accept
  the Hello Packet (see Section 10.5).  Unrecognized bits in the Hello
  Packet's Options field should be set to zero.

  In order to ensure two-way communication between adjacent routers,
  the Hello packet contains the list of all routers on the network from
  which Hello Packets have been seen recently.  The Hello packet also
  contains the router's current choice for Designated Router and Backup
  Designated Router.  A value of 0.0.0.0 in these fields means that one
  has not yet been selected.

  On broadcast networks and physical point-to-point networks, Hello
  packets are sent every HelloInterval seconds to the IP multicast
  address AllSPFRouters.  On virtual links, Hello packets are sent as
  unicasts (addressed directly to the other end of the virtual link)
  every HelloInterval seconds. On Point-to-MultiPoint networks,
  separate Hello packets are sent to each attached neighbor every
  HelloInterval seconds. Sending of Hello packets on NBMA networks is
  covered in the next section.

9.5.1.  Sending Hello packets on NBMA networks

  Static configuration information may be necessary in order for the
  Hello Protocol to function on non-broadcast networks (see Sections
  C.5 and C.6).  On NBMA networks, every attached router which is
  eligible to become Designated Router becomes aware of all of its
  neighbors on the network (either through configuration or by some
  unspecified mechanism).  Each neighbor is labelled with the
  neighbor's Designated Router eligibility.

  The interface state must be at least Waiting for any Hello Packets to
  be sent out the NBMA interface. Hello Packets are then sent directly
  (as unicasts) to some subset of a router's neighbors.  Sometimes an
  Hello Packet is sent periodically on a timer; at other times it is
  sent as a response to a received Hello Packet.  A router's hello-
  sending behavior varies depending on whether the router itself is
  eligible to become Designated Router.

  If the router is eligible to become Designated Router, it must
  periodically send Hello Packets to all neighbors that are also
  eligible. In addition, if the router is itself the Designated Router
  or Backup Designated Router, it must also send periodic Hello Packets
  to all other neighbors.  This means that any two eligible routers are
  always exchanging Hello Packets, which is necessary for the correct
  operation of the Designated Router election algorithm.  To minimize
  the number of Hello Packets sent, the number of eligible routers on
  an NBMA network should be kept small.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 67]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  If the router is not eligible to become Designated Router, it must
  periodically send Hello Packets to both the Designated Router and the
  Backup Designated Router (if they exist).  It must also send an Hello
  Packet in reply to an Hello Packet received from any eligible
  neighbor (other than the current Designated Router and Backup
  Designated Router).  This is needed to establish an initial
  bidirectional relationship with any potential Designated Router.

  When sending Hello packets periodically to any neighbor, the interval
  between Hello Packets is determined by the neighbor's state.  If the
  neighbor is in state Down, Hello Packets are sent every PollInterval
  seconds.  Otherwise, Hello Packets are sent every HelloInterval
  seconds.

10.  The Neighbor Data Structure

  An OSPF router converses with its neighboring routers.  Each separate
  conversation is described by a "neighbor data structure".  Each
  conversation is bound to a particular OSPF router interface, and is
  identified either by the neighboring router's OSPF Router ID or by
  its Neighbor IP address (see below). Thus if the OSPF router and
  another router have multiple attached networks in common, multiple
  conversations ensue, each described by a unique neighbor data
  structure.  Each separate conversation is loosely referred to in the
  text as being a separate "neighbor".

  The neighbor data structure contains all information pertinent to the
  forming or formed adjacency between the two neighbors.  (However,
  remember that not all neighbors become adjacent.)  An adjacency can
  be viewed as a highly developed conversation between two routers.

  State
     The functional level of the neighbor conversation.  This is
     described in more detail in Section 10.1.

  Inactivity Timer
     A single shot timer whose firing indicates that no Hello Packet
     has been seen from this neighbor recently.  The length of the
     timer is RouterDeadInterval seconds.

  Master/Slave
     When the two neighbors are exchanging databases, they form a
     master/slave relationship.  The master sends the first Database
     Description Packet, and is the only part that is allowed to
     retransmit.  The slave can only respond to the master's Database
     Description Packets.  The master/slave relationship is negotiated
     in state ExStart.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 68]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  DD Sequence Number
     The DD Sequence number of the Database Description packet that is
     currently being sent to the neighbor.

  Last received Database Description packet
     The initialize(I), more (M) and master(MS) bits, Options field,
     and DD sequence number contained in the last Database Description
     packet received from the neighbor. Used to determine whether the
     next Database Description packet received from the neighbor is a
     duplicate.

  Neighbor ID
     The OSPF Router ID of the neighboring router.  The Neighbor ID is
     learned when Hello packets are received from the neighbor, or is
     configured if this is a virtual adjacency (see Section C.4).

  Neighbor Priority
     The Router Priority of the neighboring router. Contained in the
     neighbor's Hello packets, this item is used when selecting the
     Designated Router for the attached network.

  Neighbor IP address
     The IP address of the neighboring router's interface to the
     attached network.  Used as the Destination IP address when
     protocol packets are sent as unicasts along this adjacency.  Also
     used in router-LSAs as the Link ID for the attached network if the
     neighboring router is selected to be Designated Router (see
     Section 12.4.1).  The Neighbor IP address is learned when Hello
     packets are received from the neighbor.  For virtual links, the
     Neighbor IP address is learned during the routing table build
     process (see Section 15).

  Neighbor Options
     The optional OSPF capabilities supported by the neighbor.  Learned
     during the Database Exchange process (see Section 10.6).  The
     neighbor's optional OSPF capabilities are also listed in its Hello
     packets. This enables received Hello Packets to be rejected (i.e.,
     neighbor relationships will not even start to form) if there is a
     mismatch in certain crucial OSPF capabilities (see Section 10.5).
     The optional OSPF capabilities are documented in Section 4.5.

  Neighbor's Designated Router
     The neighbor's idea of the Designated Router.  If this is the
     neighbor itself, this is important in the local calculation of the
     Designated Router. Defined only on broadcast and NBMA networks.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 69]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Neighbor's Backup Designated Router
     The neighbor's idea of the Backup Designated Router.  If this is
     the neighbor itself, this is important in the local calculation of
     the Backup Designated Router.  Defined only on broadcast and NBMA
     networks.

  The next set of variables are lists of LSAs.  These lists describe
  subsets of the area link-state database.  This memo defines five
  distinct types of LSAs, all of which may be present in an area link-
  state database: router-LSAs, network-LSAs, and Type 3 and 4 summary-
  LSAs (all stored in the area data structure), and AS- external-LSAs
  (stored in the global data structure).

  Link state retransmission list
     The list of LSAs that have been flooded but not acknowledged on
     this adjacency.  These will be retransmitted at intervals until
     they are acknowledged, or until the adjacency is destroyed.

  Database summary list
     The complete list of LSAs that make up the area link-state
     database, at the moment the neighbor goes into Database Exchange
     state.  This list is sent to the neighbor in Database Description
     packets.

  Link state request list
     The list of LSAs that need to be received from this neighbor in
     order to synchronize the two neighbors' link-state databases.
     This list is created as Database Description packets are received,
     and is then sent to the neighbor in Link State Request packets.
     The list is depleted as appropriate Link State Update packets are
     received.

10.1.  Neighbor states

  The state of a neighbor (really, the state of a conversation being
  held with a neighboring router) is documented in the following
  sections.  The states are listed in order of progressing
  functionality.  For example, the inoperative state is listed first,
  followed by a list of intermediate states before the final, fully
  functional state is achieved.  The specification makes use of this
  ordering by sometimes making references such as "those
  neighbors/adjacencies in state greater than X".  Figures 12 and 13
  show the graph of neighbor state changes.  The arcs of the graphs are
  labelled with the event causing the state change.  The neighbor
  events are documented in Section 10.2.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 70]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The graph in Figure 12 shows the state changes effected by the Hello
  Protocol.  The Hello Protocol is responsible for neighbor acquisition
  and maintenance, and for ensuring two way communication between
  neighbors.

  The graph in Figure 13 shows the forming of an adjacency.  Not every
  two neighboring routers become adjacent (see Section 10.4).  The
  adjacency starts to form when the neighbor is in state ExStart.
  After the two routers discover their master/slave status, the state
  transitions to Exchange.  At this point the neighbor starts to be
  used in the flooding procedure, and the two neighboring routers begin
  synchronizing their databases.  When this synchronization is
  finished, the neighbor is in state Full and we say that the two
  routers are fully adjacent.  At this point the adjacency is listed in
  LSAs.

  For a more detailed description of neighbor state changes, together
  with the additional actions involved in each change, see Section
  10.3.

  Down
     This is the initial state of a neighbor conversation.  It
     indicates that there has been no recent information received from
     the neighbor. On NBMA networks, Hello packets may still be sent to
     "Down" neighbors, although at a reduced frequency (see Section
     9.5.1).

























Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 71]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                                  +----+
                                  |Down|
                                  +----+
                                    |\
                                    | \Start
                                    |  \      +-------+
                            Hello   |   +---->|Attempt|
                           Received |         +-------+
                                    |             |
                            +----+<-+             |HelloReceived
                            |Init|<---------------+
                            +----+<--------+
                               |           |
                               |2-Way      |1-Way
                               |Received   |Received
                               |           |
             +-------+         |        +-----+
             |ExStart|<--------+------->|2-Way|
             +-------+                  +-----+

          Figure 12: Neighbor state changes (Hello Protocol)

            In addition to the state transitions pictured,
               Event KillNbr always forces Down State,
           Event Inactivity Timer always forces Down State,
                Event LLDown always forces Down State

























Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 72]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                                 +-------+
                                 |ExStart|
                                 +-------+
                                   |
                    NegotiationDone|
                                   +->+--------+
                                      |Exchange|
                                   +--+--------+
                                   |
                           Exchange|
                             Done  |
                   +----+          |      +-------+
                   |Full|<---------+----->|Loading|
                   +----+<-+              +-------+
                           |  LoadingDone     |
                           +------------------+

        Figure 13: Neighbor state changes (Database Exchange)

            In addition to the state transitions pictured,
            Event SeqNumberMismatch forces ExStart state,
                 Event BadLSReq forces ExStart state,
                    Event 1-Way forces Init state,
               Event KillNbr always forces Down State,
           Event InactivityTimer always forces Down State,
                Event LLDown always forces Down State,
           Event AdjOK? leads to adjacency forming/breaking
























Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 73]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Attempt
     This state is only valid for neighbors attached to NBMA networks.
     It indicates that no recent information has been received from the
     neighbor, but that a more concerted effort should be made to
     contact the neighbor.  This is done by sending the neighbor Hello
     packets at intervals of HelloInterval (see Section 9.5.1).

  Init
     In this state, an Hello packet has recently been seen from the
     neighbor.  However, bidirectional communication has not yet been
     established with the neighbor (i.e., the router itself did not
     appear in the neighbor's Hello packet).  All neighbors in this
     state (or higher) are listed in the Hello packets sent from the
     associated interface.

  2-Way
     In this state, communication between the two routers is
     bidirectional.  This has been assured by the operation of the
     Hello Protocol.  This is the most advanced state short of
     beginning adjacency establishment.  The (Backup) Designated Router
     is selected from the set of neighbors in state 2-Way or greater.

  ExStart
     This is the first step in creating an adjacency between the two
     neighboring routers.  The goal of this step is to decide which
     router is the master, and to decide upon the initial DD sequence
     number.  Neighbor conversations in this state or greater are
     called adjacencies.

  Exchange
     In this state the router is describing its entire link state
     database by sending Database Description packets to the neighbor.
     Each Database Description Packet has a DD sequence number, and is
     explicitly acknowledged.  Only one Database Description Packet is
     allowed outstanding at any one time.  In this state, Link State
     Request Packets may also be sent asking for the neighbor's more
     recent LSAs.  All adjacencies in Exchange state or greater are
     used by the flooding procedure.  In fact, these adjacencies are
     fully capable of transmitting and receiving all types of OSPF
     routing protocol packets.

  Loading
     In this state, Link State Request packets are sent to the neighbor
     asking for the more recent LSAs that have been discovered (but not
     yet received) in the Exchange state.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 74]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Full
     In this state, the neighboring routers are fully adjacent.  These
     adjacencies will now appear in router-LSAs and network-LSAs.

10.2.  Events causing neighbor state changes

  State changes can be effected by a number of events.  These events
  are shown in the labels of the arcs in Figures 12 and 13.  The label
  definitions are as follows:

  HelloReceived
     An Hello packet has been received from the neighbor.

  Start
     This is an indication that Hello Packets should now be sent to the
     neighbor at intervals of HelloInterval seconds.  This event is
     generated only for neighbors associated with NBMA networks.

  2-WayReceived
     Bidirectional communication has been realized between the two
     neighboring routers.  This is indicated by the router seeing
     itself in the neighbor's Hello packet.

  NegotiationDone
     The Master/Slave relationship has been negotiated, and DD sequence
     numbers have been exchanged.  This signals the start of the
     sending/receiving of Database Description packets.  For more
     information on the generation of this event, consult Section 10.8.

  ExchangeDone
     Both routers have successfully transmitted a full sequence of
     Database Description packets.  Each router now knows what parts of
     its link state database are out of date.  For more information on
     the generation of this event, consult Section 10.8.

  BadLSReq
     A Link State Request has been received for an LSA not contained in
     the database. This indicates an error in the Database Exchange
     process.

  Loading Done
     Link State Updates have been received for all out-of-date portions
     of the database.  This is indicated by the Link state request list
     becoming empty after the Database Exchange process has completed.







Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 75]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  AdjOK?
     A decision must be made as to whether an adjacency should be
     established/maintained with the neighbor.  This event will start
     some adjacencies forming, and destroy others.

  The following events cause well developed neighbors to revert to
  lesser states.  Unlike the above events, these events may occur when
  the neighbor conversation is in any of a number of states.

  SeqNumberMismatch
     A Database Description packet has been received that either a) has
     an unexpected DD sequence number, b) unexpectedly has the Init bit
     set or c) has an Options field differing from the last Options
     field received in a Database Description packet.  Any of these
     conditions indicate that some error has occurred during adjacency
     establishment.

  1-Way
     An Hello packet has been received from the neighbor, in which the
     router is not mentioned. This indicates that communication with
     the neighbor is not bidirectional.

  KillNbr
     This is an indication that all communication with the neighbor is
     now impossible, forcing the neighbor to revert to Down state.

  InactivityTimer
     The inactivity Timer has fired.  This means that no Hello packets
     have been seen recently from the neighbor. The neighbor reverts to
     Down state.

  LLDown
     This is an indication from the lower level protocols that the
     neighbor is now unreachable.  For example, on an X.25 network this
     could be indicated by an X.25 clear indication with appropriate
     cause and diagnostic fields.  This event forces the neighbor into
     Down state.

10.3.  The Neighbor state machine

  A detailed description of the neighbor state changes follows.  Each
  state change is invoked by an event (Section 10.2).  This event may
  produce different effects, depending on the current state of the
  neighbor.  For this reason, the state machine below is organized by
  current neighbor state and received event.  Each entry in the state
  machine describes the resulting new neighbor state and the required
  set of additional actions.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 76]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  When a neighbor's state changes, it may be necessary to rerun the
  Designated Router election algorithm.  This is determined by whether
  the interface NeighborChange event is generated (see Section 9.2).
  Also, if the Interface is in DR state (the router is itself
  Designated Router), changes in neighbor state may cause a new
  network-LSA to be originated (see Section 12.4).

  When the neighbor state machine needs to invoke the interface state
  machine, it should be done as a scheduled task (see Section 4.4).
  This simplifies things, by ensuring that neither state machine will
  be executed recursively.


   State(s):  Down

      Event:  Start

  New state:  Attempt

     Action:  Send an Hello Packet to the neighbor (this neighbor
              is always associated with an NBMA network) and start
              the Inactivity Timer for the neighbor.  The timer's
              later firing would indicate that communication with
              the neighbor was not attained.


   State(s):  Attempt

      Event:  HelloReceived

  New state:  Init

     Action:  Restart the Inactivity Timer for the neighbor, since
              the neighbor has now been heard from.


   State(s):  Down

      Event:  HelloReceived

  New state:  Init

     Action:  Start the Inactivity Timer for the neighbor.  The
              timer's later firing would indicate that the neighbor
              is dead.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 77]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   State(s):  Init or greater

      Event:  HelloReceived

  New state:  No state change.

     Action:  Restart the Inactivity Timer for the neighbor, since
              the neighbor has again been heard from.


   State(s):  Init

      Event:  2-WayReceived

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.

     Action:  Determine whether an adjacency should be established
              with the neighbor (see Section 10.4).  If not, the
              new neighbor state is 2-Way.

              Otherwise (an adjacency should be established) the
              neighbor state transitions to ExStart.  Upon
              entering this state, the router increments the DD
              sequence number in the neighbor data structure.  If
              this is the first time that an adjacency has been
              attempted, the DD sequence number should be assigned
              some unique value (like the time of day clock).  It
              then declares itself master (sets the master/slave
              bit to master), and starts sending Database
              Description Packets, with the initialize (I), more
              (M) and master (MS) bits set.  This Database
              Description Packet should be otherwise empty.  This
              Database Description Packet should be retransmitted
              at intervals of RxmtInterval until the next state is
              entered (see Section 10.8).


   State(s):  ExStart

      Event:  NegotiationDone

  New state:  Exchange

     Action:  The router must list the contents of its entire area
              link state database in the neighbor Database summary
              list.  The area link state database consists of the
              router-LSAs, network-LSAs and summary-LSAs contained
              in the area structure, along with the AS-external-



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 78]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


              LSAs contained in the global structure.  AS-
              external-LSAs are omitted from a virtual neighbor's
              Database summary list.  AS-external-LSAs are omitted
              from the Database summary list if the area has been
              configured as a stub (see Section 3.6).  LSAs whose
              age is equal to MaxAge are instead added to the
              neighbor's Link state retransmission list.  A
              summary of the Database summary list will be sent to
              the neighbor in Database Description packets.  Each
              Database Description Packet has a DD sequence
              number, and is explicitly acknowledged.  Only one
              Database Description Packet is allowed outstanding
              at any one time.  For more detail on the sending and
              receiving of Database Description packets, see
              Sections 10.8 and 10.6.


   State(s):  Exchange

      Event:  ExchangeDone

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.

     Action:  If the neighbor Link state request list is empty,
              the new neighbor state is Full.  No other action is
              required.  This is an adjacency's final state.

              Otherwise, the new neighbor state is Loading.  Start
              (or continue) sending Link State Request packets to
              the neighbor (see Section 10.9).  These are requests
              for the neighbor's more recent LSAs (which were
              discovered but not yet received in the Exchange
              state).  These LSAs are listed in the Link state
              request list associated with the neighbor.


   State(s):  Loading

      Event:  Loading Done

  New state:  Full

     Action:  No action required.  This is an adjacency's final
              state.







Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 79]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   State(s):  2-Way

      Event:  AdjOK?

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.

     Action:  Determine whether an adjacency should be formed with
              the neighboring router (see Section 10.4).  If not,
              the neighbor state remains at 2-Way.  Otherwise,
              transition the neighbor state to ExStart and perform
              the actions associated with the above state machine
              entry for state Init and event 2-WayReceived.


   State(s):  ExStart or greater

      Event:  AdjOK?

  New state:  Depends upon action routine.

     Action:  Determine whether the neighboring router should
              still be adjacent.  If yes, there is no state change
              and no further action is necessary.

              Otherwise, the (possibly partially formed) adjacency
              must be destroyed.  The neighbor state transitions
              to 2-Way.  The Link state retransmission list,
              Database summary list and Link state request list
              are cleared of LSAs.


   State(s):  Exchange or greater

      Event:  SeqNumberMismatch

  New state:  ExStart

     Action:  The (possibly partially formed) adjacency is torn
              down, and then an attempt is made at
              reestablishment.  The neighbor state first
              transitions to ExStart.  The Link state
              retransmission list, Database summary list and Link
              state request list are cleared of LSAs.  Then the
              router increments the DD sequence number in the
              neighbor data structure, declares itself master
              (sets the master/slave bit to master), and starts
              sending Database Description Packets, with the
              initialize (I), more (M) and master (MS) bits set.



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 80]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


              This Database Description Packet should be otherwise
              empty (see Section 10.8).


   State(s):  Exchange or greater

      Event:  BadLSReq

  New state:  ExStart

     Action:  The action for event BadLSReq is exactly the same as
              for the neighbor event SeqNumberMismatch.  The
              (possibly partially formed) adjacency is torn down,
              and then an attempt is made at reestablishment.  For
              more information, see the neighbor state machine
              entry that is invoked when event SeqNumberMismatch
              is generated in state Exchange or greater.


   State(s):  Any state

      Event:  KillNbr

  New state:  Down

     Action:  The Link state retransmission list, Database summary
              list and Link state request list are cleared of
              LSAs.  Also, the Inactivity Timer is disabled.


   State(s):  Any state

      Event:  LLDown

  New state:  Down

     Action:  The Link state retransmission list, Database summary
              list and Link state request list are cleared of
              LSAs.  Also, the Inactivity Timer is disabled.












Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 81]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


   State(s):  Any state

      Event:  InactivityTimer

  New state:  Down

     Action:  The Link state retransmission list, Database summary
              list and Link state request list are cleared of
              LSAs.


   State(s):  2-Way or greater

      Event:  1-WayReceived

  New state:  Init

     Action:  The Link state retransmission list, Database summary
              list and Link state request list are cleared of
              LSAs.


   State(s):  2-Way or greater

      Event:  2-WayReceived

  New state:  No state change.

     Action:  No action required.


   State(s):  Init

      Event:  1-WayReceived

  New state:  No state change.

     Action:  No action required.


10.4.  Whether to become adjacent

  Adjacencies are established with some subset of the router's
  neighbors.  Routers connected by point-to-point networks, Point-to-
  MultiPoint networks and virtual links always become adjacent.  On
  broadcast and NBMA networks, all routers become adjacent to both the
  Designated Router and the Backup Designated Router.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 82]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The adjacency-forming decision occurs in two places in the neighbor
  state machine.  First, when bidirectional communication is initially
  established with the neighbor, and secondly, when the identity of the
  attached network's (Backup) Designated Router changes.  If the
  decision is made to not attempt an adjacency, the state of the
  neighbor communication stops at 2-Way.

  An adjacency should be established with a bidirectional neighbor when
  at least one of the following conditions holds:

  o   The underlying network type is point-to-point

  o   The underlying network type is Point-to-MultiPoint

  o   The underlying network type is virtual link

  o   The router itself is the Designated Router

  o   The router itself is the Backup Designated Router

  o   The neighboring router is the Designated Router

  o   The neighboring router is the Backup Designated Router

10.5.  Receiving Hello Packets

  This section explains the detailed processing of a received Hello
  Packet.  (See Section A.3.2 for the format of Hello packets.)  The
  generic input processing of OSPF packets will have checked the
  validity of the IP header and the OSPF packet header.  Next, the
  values of the Network Mask, HelloInterval, and RouterDeadInterval
  fields in the received Hello packet must be checked against the
  values configured for the receiving interface.  Any mismatch causes
  processing to stop and the packet to be dropped.  In other words, the
  above fields are really describing the attached network's
  configuration.  However, there is one exception to the above rule: on
  point-to-point networks and on virtual links, the Network Mask in the
  received Hello Packet should be ignored.

  The receiving interface attaches to a single OSPF area (this could be
  the backbone).  The setting of the E-bit found in the Hello Packet's
  Options field must match this area's ExternalRoutingCapability.  If
  AS-external-LSAs are not flooded into/throughout the area (i.e, the
  area is a "stub") the E-bit must be clear in received Hello Packets,
  otherwise the E-bit must be set.  A mismatch causes processing to
  stop and the packet to be dropped.  The setting of the rest of the
  bits in the Hello Packet's Options field should be ignored.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 83]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  At this point, an attempt is made to match the source of the Hello
  Packet to one of the receiving interface's neighbors.  If the
  receiving interface connects to a broadcast, Point-to-MultiPoint or
  NBMA network the source is identified by the IP source address found
  in the Hello's IP header.  If the receiving interface connects to a
  point-to-point link or a virtual link, the source is identified by
  the Router ID found in the Hello's OSPF packet header.  The
  interface's current list of neighbors is contained in the interface's
  data structure.  If a matching neighbor structure cannot be found,
  (i.e., this is the first time the neighbor has been detected), one is
  created.  The initial state of a newly created neighbor is set to
  Down.

  When receiving an Hello Packet from a neighbor on a broadcast,
  Point-to-MultiPoint or NBMA network, set the neighbor structure's
  Neighbor ID equal to the Router ID found in the packet's OSPF header.
  When receiving an Hello on a point-to-point network (but not on a
  virtual link) set the neighbor structure's Neighbor IP address to the
  packet's IP source address.

  Now the rest of the Hello Packet is examined, generating events to be
  given to the neighbor and interface state machines.  These state
  machines are specified either to be executed or scheduled (see
  Section 4.4).  For example, by specifying below that the neighbor
  state machine be executed in line, several neighbor state transitions
  may be effected by a single received Hello:

  o   Each Hello Packet causes the neighbor state machine to be
      executed with the event HelloReceived.

  o   Then the list of neighbors contained in the Hello Packet is
      examined.  If the router itself appears in this list, the
      neighbor state machine should be executed with the event 2-
      WayReceived.  Otherwise, the neighbor state machine should
      be executed with the event 1-WayReceived, and the processing
      of the packet stops.

  o   Next, the Hello Packet's Router Priority field is examined.
      If this field is different than the one previously received
      from the neighbor, the receiving interface's state machine
      is scheduled with the event NeighborChange.  In any case,
      the Router Priority field in the neighbor data structure
      should be updated accordingly.

  o   Next the Designated Router field in the Hello Packet is
      examined.  If the neighbor is both declaring itself to be
      Designated Router (Designated Router field = Neighbor IP
      address) and the Backup Designated Router field in the



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 84]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      packet is equal to 0.0.0.0 and the receiving interface is in
      state Waiting, the receiving interface's state machine is
      scheduled with the event BackupSeen.  Otherwise, if the
      neighbor is declaring itself to be Designated Router and it
      had not previously, or the neighbor is not declaring itself
      Designated Router where it had previously, the receiving
      interface's state machine is scheduled with the event
      NeighborChange.  In any case, the Neighbors' Designated
      Router item in the neighbor structure is updated
      accordingly.

  o   Finally, the Backup Designated Router field in the Hello
      Packet is examined.  If the neighbor is declaring itself to
      be Backup Designated Router (Backup Designated Router field
      = Neighbor IP address) and the receiving interface is in
      state Waiting, the receiving interface's state machine is
      scheduled with the event BackupSeen.  Otherwise, if the
      neighbor is declaring itself to be Backup Designated Router
      and it had not previously, or the neighbor is not declaring
      itself Backup Designated Router where it had previously, the
      receiving interface's state machine is scheduled with the
      event NeighborChange.  In any case, the Neighbor's Backup
      Designated Router item in the neighbor structure is updated
      accordingly.

  On NBMA networks, receipt of an Hello Packet may also cause an Hello
  Packet to be sent back to the neighbor in response. See Section 9.5.1
  for more details.

10.6.  Receiving Database Description Packets

  This section explains the detailed processing of a received Database
  Description Packet.  The incoming Database Description Packet has
  already been associated with a neighbor and receiving interface by
  the generic input packet processing (Section 8.2).  Whether the
  Database Description packet should be accepted, and if so, how it
  should be further processed depends upon the neighbor state.

  If a Database Description packet is accepted, the following packet
  fields should be saved in the corresponding neighbor data structure
  under "last received Database Description packet": the packet's
  initialize(I), more (M) and master(MS) bits, Options field, and DD
  sequence number. If these fields are set identically in two
  consecutive Database Description packets received from the neighbor,
  the second Database Description packet is considered to be a
  "duplicate" in the processing described below.





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 85]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  If the Interface MTU field in the Database Description packet
  indicates an IP datagram size that is larger than the router can
  accept on the receiving interface without fragmentation, the Database
  Description packet is rejected.  Otherwise, if the neighbor state is:

  Down
     The packet should be rejected.

  Attempt
     The packet should be rejected.

  Init
     The neighbor state machine should be executed with the event 2-
     WayReceived.  This causes an immediate state change to either
     state 2-Way or state ExStart. If the new state is ExStart, the
     processing of the current packet should then continue in this new
     state by falling through to case ExStart below.

  2-Way
     The packet should be ignored.  Database Description Packets are
     used only for the purpose of bringing up adjacencies.[7]

  ExStart
     If the received packet matches one of the following cases, then
     the neighbor state machine should be executed with the event
     NegotiationDone (causing the state to transition to Exchange), the
     packet's Options field should be recorded in the neighbor
     structure's Neighbor Options field and the packet should be
     accepted as next in sequence and processed further (see below).
     Otherwise, the packet should be ignored.

      o   The initialize(I), more (M) and master(MS) bits are set,
          the contents of the packet are empty, and the neighbor's
          Router ID is larger than the router's own.  In this case
          the router is now Slave.  Set the master/slave bit to
          slave, and set the neighbor data structure's DD sequence
          number to that specified by the master.

      o   The initialize(I) and master(MS) bits are off, the
          packet's DD sequence number equals the neighbor data
          structure's DD sequence number (indicating
          acknowledgment) and the neighbor's Router ID is smaller
          than the router's own.  In this case the router is
          Master.







Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 86]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Exchange
     Duplicate Database Description packets are discarded by the
     master, and cause the slave to retransmit the last Database
     Description packet that it had sent. Otherwise (the packet is not
     a duplicate):

      o   If the state of the MS-bit is inconsistent with the
          master/slave state of the connection, generate the
          neighbor event SeqNumberMismatch and stop processing the
          packet.

      o   If the initialize(I) bit is set, generate the neighbor
          event SeqNumberMismatch and stop processing the packet.

      o   If the packet's Options field indicates a different set
          of optional OSPF capabilities than were previously
          received from the neighbor (recorded in the Neighbor
          Options field of the neighbor structure), generate the
          neighbor event SeqNumberMismatch and stop processing the
          packet.

      o   Database Description packets must be processed in
          sequence, as indicated by the packets' DD sequence
          numbers. If the router is master, the next packet
          received should have DD sequence number equal to the DD
          sequence number in the neighbor data structure. If the
          router is slave, the next packet received should have DD
          sequence number equal to one more than the DD sequence
          number stored in the neighbor data structure. In either
          case, if the packet is the next in sequence it should be
          accepted and its contents processed as specified below.

      o   Else, generate the neighbor event SeqNumberMismatch and
          stop processing the packet.

  Loading or Full
     In this state, the router has sent and received an entire sequence
     of Database Description Packets.  The only packets received should
     be duplicates (see above). In particular, the packet's Options
     field should match the set of optional OSPF capabilities
     previously indicated by the neighbor (stored in the neighbor
     structure's Neighbor Options field).  Any other packets received,
     including the reception of a packet with the Initialize(I) bit
     set, should generate the neighbor event SeqNumberMismatch.[8]
     Duplicates should be discarded by the master.  The slave must
     respond to duplicates by repeating the last Database Description
     packet that it had sent.




Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 87]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  When the router accepts a received Database Description Packet as the
  next in sequence the packet contents are processed as follows.  For
  each LSA listed, the LSA's LS type is checked for validity.  If the
  LS type is unknown (e.g., not one of the LS types 1-5 defined by this
  specification), or if this is an AS-external-LSA (LS type = 5) and
  the neighbor is associated with a stub area, generate the neighbor
  event SeqNumberMismatch and stop processing the packet.  Otherwise,
  the router looks up the LSA in its database to see whether it also
  has an instance of the LSA.  If it does not, or if the database copy
  is less recent (see Section 13.1), the LSA is put on the Link state
  request list so that it can be requested (immediately or at some
  later time) in Link State Request Packets.

  When the router accepts a received Database Description Packet as the
  next in sequence, it also performs the following actions, depending
  on whether it is master or slave:

  Master
     Increments the DD sequence number in the neighbor data structure.
     If the router has already sent its entire sequence of Database
     Description Packets, and the just accepted packet has the more bit
     (M) set to 0, the neighbor event ExchangeDone is generated.
     Otherwise, it should send a new Database Description to the slave.

  Slave
     Sets the DD sequence number in the neighbor data structure to the
     DD sequence number appearing in the received packet.  The slave
     must send a Database Description Packet in reply.  If the received
     packet has the more bit (M) set to 0, and the packet to be sent by
     the slave will also have the M-bit set to 0, the neighbor event
     ExchangeDone is generated.  Note that the slave always generates
     this event before the master.

10.7.  Receiving Link State Request Packets

  This section explains the detailed processing of received Link State
  Request packets.  Received Link State Request Packets specify a list
  of LSAs that the neighbor wishes to receive.  Link State Request
  Packets should be accepted when the neighbor is in states Exchange,
  Loading, or Full.  In all other states Link State Request Packets
  should be ignored.










Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 88]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Each LSA specified in the Link State Request packet should be located
  in the router's database, and copied into Link State Update packets
  for transmission to the neighbor.  These LSAs should NOT be placed on
  the Link state retransmission list for the neighbor.  If an LSA
  cannot be found in the database, something has gone wrong with the
  Database Exchange process, and neighbor event BadLSReq should be
  generated.

10.8.  Sending Database Description Packets

  This section describes how Database Description Packets are sent to a
  neighbor. The Database Description packet's Interface MTU field is
  set to the size of the largest IP datagram that can be sent out the
  sending interface, without fragmentation.  Common MTUs in use in the
  Internet can be found in Table 7-1 of [Ref22]. Interface MTU should
  be set to 0 in Database Description packets sent over virtual links.

  The router's optional OSPF capabilities (see Section 4.5) are
  transmitted to the neighbor in the Options field of the Database
  Description packet.  The router should maintain the same set of
  optional capabilities throughout the Database Exchange and flooding
  procedures.  If for some reason the router's optional capabilities
  change, the Database Exchange procedure should be restarted by
  reverting to neighbor state ExStart.  One optional capability is
  defined in this specification (see Sections 4.5 and A.2). The E-bit
  should be set if and only if the attached network belongs to a non-
  stub area. Unrecognized bits in the Options field should be set to
  zero.  The sending of Database Description packets depends on the
  neighbor's state.  In state ExStart the router sends empty Database
  Description packets, with the initialize (I), more (M) and master
  (MS) bits set.  These packets are retransmitted every RxmtInterval
  seconds.

  In state Exchange the Database Description Packets actually contain
  summaries of the link state information contained in the router's
  database.  Each LSA in the area's link-state database (at the time
  the neighbor transitions into Exchange state) is listed in the
  neighbor Database summary list.  Each new Database Description Packet
  copies its DD sequence number from the neighbor data structure and
  then describes the current top of the Database summary list.  Items
  are removed from the Database summary list when the previous packet
  is acknowledged.

  In state Exchange, the determination of when to send a Database
  Description packet depends on whether the router is master or slave:






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 89]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Master
     Database Description packets are sent when either a) the slave
     acknowledges the previous Database Description packet by echoing
     the DD sequence number or b) RxmtInterval seconds elapse without
     an acknowledgment, in which case the previous Database Description
     packet is retransmitted.

  Slave
     Database Description packets are sent only in response to Database
     Description packets received from the master.  If the Database
     Description packet received from the master is new, a new Database
     Description packet is sent, otherwise the previous Database
     Description packet is resent.

  In states Loading and Full the slave must resend its last Database
  Description packet in response to duplicate Database Description
  packets received from the master.  For this reason the slave must
  wait RouterDeadInterval seconds before freeing the last Database
  Description packet.  Reception of a Database Description packet from
  the master after this interval will generate a SeqNumberMismatch
  neighbor event.

10.9.  Sending Link State Request Packets

  In neighbor states Exchange or Loading, the Link state request list
  contains a list of those LSAs that need to be obtained from the
  neighbor.  To request these LSAs, a router sends the neighbor the
  beginning of the Link state request list, packaged in a Link State
  Request packet.

  When the neighbor responds to these requests with the proper Link
  State Update packet(s), the Link state request list is truncated and
  a new Link State Request packet is sent.  This process continues
  until the Link state request list becomes empty.  Unsatisfied Link
  State Request packets are retransmitted at intervals of RxmtInterval.
  There should be at most one Link State Request packet outstanding at
  any one time.

  When the Link state request list becomes empty, and the neighbor
  state is Loading (i.e., a complete sequence of Database Description
  packets has been sent to and received from the neighbor), the Loading
  Done neighbor event is generated.









Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 90]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


10.10.  An Example

  Figure 14 shows an example of an adjacency forming.  Routers RT1 and
  RT2 are both connected to a broadcast network.  It is assumed that
  RT2 is the Designated Router for the network, and that RT2 has a
  higher Router ID than Router RT1.

  The neighbor state changes realized by each router are listed on the
  sides of the figure.

  At the beginning of Figure 14, Router RT1's interface to the network
  becomes operational.  It begins sending Hello Packets, although it
  doesn't know the identity of the Designated Router or of any other
  neighboring routers.  Router RT2 hears this hello (moving the
  neighbor to Init state), and in its next Hello Packet indicates that
  it is itself the Designated Router and that it has heard Hello
  Packets from RT1.  This in turn causes RT1 to go to state ExStart, as
  it starts to bring up the adjacency.

  RT1 begins by asserting itself as the master.  When it sees that RT2
  is indeed the master (because of RT2's higher Router ID), RT1
  transitions to slave state and adopts its neighbor's DD sequence
  number.  Database Description packets are then exchanged, with polls
  coming from the master (RT2) and responses from the slave (RT1).
  This sequence of Database Description Packets ends when both the poll
  and associated response has the M-bit off.

  In this example, it is assumed that RT2 has a completely up to date
  database.  In that case, RT2 goes immediately into Full state.  RT1
  will go into Full state after updating the necessary parts of its
  database.  This is done by sending Link State Request Packets, and
  receiving Link State Update Packets in response.  Note that, while
  RT1 has waited until a complete set of Database Description Packets
  has been received (from RT2) before sending any Link State Request
  Packets, this need not be the case.  RT1 could have interleaved the
  sending of Link State Request Packets with the reception of Database
  Description Packets.














Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 91]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


           +---+                                         +---+
           |RT1|                                         |RT2|
           +---+                                         +---+

           Down                                          Down
                           Hello(DR=0,seen=0)
                      ------------------------------>
                        Hello (DR=RT2,seen=RT1,...)      Init
                      <------------------------------
           ExStart        D-D (Seq=x,I,M,Master)
                      ------------------------------>
                          D-D (Seq=y,I,M,Master)         ExStart
                      <------------------------------
           Exchange       D-D (Seq=y,M,Slave)
                      ------------------------------>
                          D-D (Seq=y+1,M,Master)         Exchange
                      <------------------------------
                          D-D (Seq=y+1,M,Slave)
                      ------------------------------>
                                    ...
                                    ...
                                    ...
                          D-D (Seq=y+n, Master)
                      <------------------------------
                          D-D (Seq=y+n, Slave)
            Loading   ------------------------------>
                                LS Request                Full
                      ------------------------------>
                                LS Update
                      <------------------------------
                                LS Request
                      ------------------------------>
                                LS Update
                      <------------------------------
            Full


               Figure 14: An adjacency bring-up example













Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 92]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


11.  The Routing Table Structure

  The routing table data structure contains all the information
  necessary to forward an IP data packet toward its destination.  Each
  routing table entry describes the collection of best paths to a
  particular destination.  When forwarding an IP data packet, the
  routing table entry providing the best match for the packet's IP
  destination is located.  The matching routing table entry then
  provides the next hop towards the packet's destination.  OSPF also
  provides for the existence of a default route (Destination ID =
  DefaultDestination, Address Mask = 0x00000000).  When the default
  route exists, it matches all IP destinations (although any other
  matching entry is a better match). Finding the routing table entry
  that best matches an IP destination is further described in Section
  11.1.

  There is a single routing table in each router.  Two sample routing
  tables are described in Sections 11.2 and 11.3.  The building of the
  routing table is discussed in Section 16.

  The rest of this section defines the fields found in a routing table
  entry.  The first set of fields describes the routing table entry's
  destination.

  Destination Type
     Destination type is either "network" or "router". Only network entries
     are actually used when forwarding IP data traffic.  Router routing
     table entries are used solely as intermediate steps in the routing
     table build process.

     A network is a range of IP addresses, to which IP data traffic may be
     forwarded.  This includes IP networks (class A, B, or C), IP subnets,
     IP supernets and single IP hosts.  The default route also falls into
     this category.

     Router entries are kept for area border routers and AS boundary
     routers.  Routing table entries for area border routers are used when
     calculating the inter-area routes (see Section 16.2), and when
     maintaining configured virtual links (see Section 15).  Routing table
     entries for AS boundary routers are used when calculating the AS
     external routes (see Section 16.4).

  Destination ID
     The destination's identifier or name.  This depends on the
     Destination Type.  For networks, the identifier is their associated IP
     address.  For routers, the identifier is the OSPF Router ID.[9]





Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 93]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Address Mask
     Only defined for networks.  The network's IP address together with its
     address mask defines a range of IP addresses.  For IP subnets, the
     address mask is referred to as the subnet mask.  For host routes, the
     mask is "all ones" (0xffffffff).

  Optional Capabilities
     When the destination is a router this field indicates the optional
     OSPF capabilities supported by the destination router.  The only
     optional capability defined by this specification is the ability to
     process AS-external-LSAs.  For a further discussion of OSPF's optional
     capabilities, see Section 4.5.

  The set of paths to use for a destination may vary based on the OSPF
  area to which the paths belong.  This means that there may be
  multiple routing table entries for the same destination, depending on
  the values of the next field.

  Area
     This field indicates the area whose link state information has led
     to the routing table entry's collection of paths.  This is called
     the entry's associated area.  For sets of AS external paths, this
     field is not defined.  For destinations of type "router", there
     may be separate sets of paths (and therefore separate routing
     table entries) associated with each of several areas. For example,
     this will happen when two area border routers share multiple areas
     in common.  For destinations of type "network", only the set of
     paths associated with the best area (the one providing the
     preferred route) is kept.

  The rest of the routing table entry describes the set of paths to the
  destination.  The following fields pertain to the set of paths as a
  whole.  In other words, each one of the paths contained in a routing
  table entry is of the same path-type and cost (see below).

  Path-type
     There are four possible types of paths used to route traffic to
     the destination, listed here in order of preference: intra-area,
     inter-area, type 1 external or type 2 external.  Intra-area paths
     indicate destinations belonging to one of the router's attached
     areas.  Inter-area paths are paths to destinations in other OSPF
     areas.  These are discovered through the examination of received
     summary-LSAs.  AS external paths are paths to destinations
     external to the AS.  These are detected through the examination of
     received AS-external-LSAs.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 94]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Cost
     The link state cost of the path to the destination.  For all paths
     except type 2 external paths this describes the entire path's
     cost.  For Type 2 external paths, this field describes the cost of
     the portion of the path internal to the AS.  This cost is
     calculated as the sum of the costs of the path's constituent
     links.

  Type 2 cost
     Only valid for type 2 external paths.  For these paths, this field
     indicates the cost of the path's external portion.  This cost has
     been advertised by an AS boundary router, and is the most
     significant part of the total path cost.  For example, a type 2
     external path with type 2 cost of 5 is always preferred over a
     path with type 2 cost of 10, regardless of the cost of the two
     paths' internal components.

  Link State Origin
     Valid only for intra-area paths, this field indicates the LSA
     (router-LSA or network-LSA) that directly references the
     destination.  For example, if the destination is a transit
     network, this is the transit network's network-LSA.  If the
     destination is a stub network, this is the router-LSA for the
     attached router.  The LSA is discovered during the shortest-path
     tree calculation (see Section 16.1).  Multiple LSAs may reference
     the destination, however a tie-breaking scheme always reduces the
     choice to a single LSA. The Link State Origin field is not used by
     the OSPF protocol, but it is used by the routing table calculation
     in OSPF's Multicast routing extensions (MOSPF).

  When multiple paths of equal path-type and cost exist to a
  destination (called elsewhere "equal-cost" paths), they are stored in
  a single routing table entry.  Each one of the "equal-cost" paths is
  distinguished by the following fields:

  Next hop
     The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to
     the destination.  On broadcast, Point-to-MultiPoint and NBMA
     networks, the next hop also includes the IP address of the next
     router (if any) in the path towards the destination.

  Advertising router
     Valid only for inter-area and AS external paths.  This field
     indicates the Router ID of the router advertising the summary-LSA
     or AS-external-LSA that led to this path.






Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 95]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


11.1.  Routing table lookup

  When an IP data packet is received, an OSPF router finds the routing
  table entry that best matches the packet's destination.  This routing
  table entry then provides the outgoing interface and next hop router
  to use in forwarding the packet. This section describes the process
  of finding the best matching routing table entry. The process
  consists of a number of steps, wherein the collection of routing
  table entries is progressively pruned.  In the end, the single
  routing table entry remaining is called the "best match".

  Before the lookup begins, "discard" routing table entries should be
  inserted into the routing table for each of the router's active area
  address ranges (see Section 3.5).  (An area range is considered
  "active" if the range contains one or more networks reachable by
  intra-area paths.) The destination of a "discard" entry is the set of
  addresses described by its associated active area address range, and
  the path type of each "discard" entry is set to "inter-area".[10]

  Note that the steps described below may fail to produce a best match
  routing table entry (i.e., all existing routing table entries are
  pruned for some reason or another), or the best match routing table
  entry may be one of the above "discard" routing table entries. In
  these cases, the packet's IP destination is considered unreachable.
  Instead of being forwarded, the packet should be discarded and an
  ICMP destination unreachable message should be returned to the
  packet's source.

  (1) Select the complete set of "matching" routing table entries
      from the routing table.  Each routing table entry describes
      a (set of) path(s) to a range of IP addresses. If the data
      packet's IP destination falls into an entry's range of IP
      addresses, the routing table entry is called a match. (It is
      quite likely that multiple entries will match the data
      packet.  For example, a default route will match all
      packets.)

  (2) Reduce the set of matching entries to those having the most
      preferential path-type (see Section 11). OSPF has a four
      level hierarchy of paths. Intra-area paths are the most
      preferred, followed in order by inter-area, type 1 external
      and type 2 external paths.

  (3) Select the remaining routing table entry that provides the
      most specific (longest) match. Another way of saying this is
      to choose the remaining entry that specifies the narrowest
      range of IP addresses.[11] For example, the entry for the
      address/mask pair of (128.185.1.0, 0xffffff00) is more



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 96]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      specific than an entry for the pair (128.185.0.0,
      0xffff0000). The default route is the least specific match,
      since it matches all destinations.

11.2.  Sample routing table, without areas

  Consider the Autonomous System pictured in Figure 2.  No OSPF areas
  have been configured.  A single metric is shown per outbound
  interface.  The calculation of Router RT6's routing table proceeds as
  described in Section 2.2.  The resulting routing table is shown in
  Table 12.  Destination types are abbreviated: Network as "N", Router
  as "R".

  There are no instances of multiple equal-cost shortest paths in this
  example.  Also, since there are no areas, there are no inter-area
  paths.

  Routers RT5 and RT7 are AS boundary routers.  Intra-area routes have
  been calculated to Routers RT5 and RT7.  This allows external routes
  to be calculated to the destinations advertised by RT5 and RT7 (i.e.,
  Networks N12, N13, N14 and N15).  It is assumed all AS-external-LSAs
  originated by RT5 and RT7 are advertising type 1 external metrics.
  This results in type 1 external paths being calculated to
  destinations N12-N15.

11.3.  Sample routing table, with areas

  Consider the previous example, this time split into OSPF areas.  An
  OSPF area configuration is pictured in Figure 6.  Router RT4's
  routing table will be described for this area configuration.  Router
  RT4 has a connection to Area 1 and a backbone connection.  This
  causes Router RT4 to view the AS as the concatenation of the two
  graphs shown in Figures 7 and 8.  The resulting routing table is
  displayed in Table 13.

















Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 97]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


     Type   Dest   Area   Path  Type    Cost   Next     Adv.
                                               Hop(s)   Router(s)
     ____________________________________________________________
     N      N1     0      intra-area    10     RT3      *
     N      N2     0      intra-area    10     RT3      *
     N      N3     0      intra-area    7      RT3      *
     N      N4     0      intra-area    8      RT3      *
     N      Ib     0      intra-area    7      *        *
     N      Ia     0      intra-area    12     RT10     *
     N      N6     0      intra-area    8      RT10     *
     N      N7     0      intra-area    12     RT10     *
     N      N8     0      intra-area    10     RT10     *
     N      N9     0      intra-area    11     RT10     *
     N      N10    0      intra-area    13     RT10     *
     N      N11    0      intra-area    14     RT10     *
     N      H1     0      intra-area    21     RT10     *
     R      RT5    0      intra-area    6      RT5      *
     R      RT7    0      intra-area    8      RT10     *
     ____________________________________________________________
     N      N12    *      type 1 ext.   10     RT10     RT7
     N      N13    *      type 1 ext.   14     RT5      RT5
     N      N14    *      type 1 ext.   14     RT5      RT5
     N      N15    *      type 1 ext.   17     RT10     RT7


              Table 12: The routing table for Router RT6
                        (no configured areas).

  Again, Routers RT5 and RT7 are AS boundary routers.  Routers RT3,
  RT4, RT7, RT10 and RT11 are area border routers.  Note that there are
  two routing entries for the area border router RT3, since it has two
  areas in common with RT4 (Area 1 and the backbone).

  Backbone paths have been calculated to all area border routers.
  These are used when determining the inter-area routes.  Note that all
  of the inter-area routes are associated with the backbone; this is
  always the case when the calculating router is itself an area border
  router.  Routing information is condensed at area boundaries.  In
  this example, we assume that Area 3 has been defined so that networks
  N9-N11 and the host route to H1 are all condensed to a single route
  when advertised into the backbone (by Router RT11).  Note that the
  cost of this route is the maximum of the set of costs to its
  individual components.








Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 98]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  There is a virtual link configured between Routers RT10 and RT11.
  Without this configured virtual link, RT11 would be unable to
  advertise a route for networks N9-N11 and Host H1 into the backbone,
  and there would not be an entry for these networks in Router RT4's
  routing table.

  In this example there are two equal-cost paths to Network N12.
  However, they both use the same next hop (Router RT5).


  Type   Dest        Area   Path  Type    Cost   Next      Adv.
                                                 Hops(s)   Router(s)
  __________________________________________________________________
  N      N1          1      intra-area    4      RT1       *
  N      N2          1      intra-area    4      RT2       *
  N      N3          1      intra-area    1      *         *
  N      N4          1      intra-area    3      RT3       *
  R      RT3         1      intra-area    1      *         *
  __________________________________________________________________
  N      Ib          0      intra-area    22     RT5       *
  N      Ia          0      intra-area    27     RT5       *
  R      RT3         0      intra-area    21     RT5       *
  R      RT5         0      intra-area    8      *         *
  R      RT7         0      intra-area    14     RT5       *
  R      RT10        0      intra-area    22     RT5       *
  R      RT11        0      intra-area    25     RT5       *
  __________________________________________________________________
  N      N6          0      inter-area    15     RT5       RT7
  N      N7          0      inter-area    19     RT5       RT7
  N      N8          0      inter-area    18     RT5       RT7
  N      N9-N11,H1   0      inter-area    36     RT5       RT11
  __________________________________________________________________
  N      N12         *      type 1 ext.   16     RT5       RT5,RT7
  N      N13         *      type 1 ext.   16     RT5       RT5
  N      N14         *      type 1 ext.   16     RT5       RT5
  N      N15         *      type 1 ext.   23     RT5       RT7

                 Table 13: Router RT4's routing table
                      in the presence of areas.


  Router RT4's routing table would improve (i.e., some of the paths in
  the routing table would become shorter) if an additional virtual link
  were configured between Router RT4 and Router RT3.  The new virtual
  link would itself be associated with the first entry for area border
  router RT3 in Table 13 (an intra-area path through Area 1).  This
  would yield a cost of 1 for the virtual link.  The routing table
  entries changes that would be caused by the addition of this virtual



Moy                         Standards Track                    [Page 99]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  link are shown in Table 14.

12.  Link State Advertisements (LSAs)

  Each router in the Autonomous System originates one or more link
  state advertisements (LSAs).  This memo defines five distinct types
  of LSAs, which are described in Section 4.3.  The collection of LSAs
  forms the link-state database.  Each separate type of LSA has a
  separate function. Router-LSAs and network-LSAs describe how an
  area's routers and networks are interconnected.  Summary-LSAs provide
  a way of condensing an area's routing information. AS-external-LSAs
  provide a way of transparently advertising externally-derived routing
  information throughout the Autonomous System.

  Each LSA begins with a standard 20-byte header.  This LSA header is
  discussed below.

   Type   Dest        Area   Path  Type   Cost   Next     Adv.
                                                 Hop(s)   Router(s)
   ________________________________________________________________
   N      Ib          0      intra-area   16     RT3      *
   N      Ia          0      intra-area   21     RT3      *
   R      RT3         0      intra-area   1      *        *
   R      RT10        0      intra-area   16     RT3      *
   R      RT11        0      intra-area   19     RT3      *
   ________________________________________________________________
   N      N9-N11,H1   0      inter-area   30     RT3      RT11


                 Table 14: Changes resulting from an
                       additional virtual link.

12.1.  The LSA Header

  The LSA header contains the LS type, Link State ID and Advertising
  Router fields.  The combination of these three fields uniquely
  identifies the LSA.

  There may be several instances of an LSA present in the Autonomous
  System, all at the same time.  It must then be determined which
  instance is more recent.  This determination is made by examining the
  LS sequence, LS checksum and LS age fields.  These fields are also
  contained in the 20-byte LSA header.

  Several of the OSPF packet types list LSAs.  When the instance is not
  important, an LSA is referred to by its LS type, Link State ID and
  Advertising Router (see Link State Request Packets).  Otherwise, the
  LS sequence number, LS age and LS checksum fields must also be



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 100]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  referenced.

  A detailed explanation of the fields contained in the LSA header
  follows.

12.1.1.  LS age

  This field is the age of the LSA in seconds.  It should be processed
  as an unsigned 16-bit integer.  It is set to 0 when the LSA is
  originated.  It must be incremented by InfTransDelay on every hop of
  the flooding procedure.  LSAs are also aged as they are held in each
  router's database.

  The age of an LSA is never incremented past MaxAge.  LSAs having age
  MaxAge are not used in the routing table calculation.  When an LSA's
  age first reaches MaxAge, it is reflooded. An LSA of age MaxAge is
  finally flushed from the database when it is no longer needed to
  ensure database synchronization.  For more information on the aging
  of LSAs, consult Section 14.

  The LS age field is examined when a router receives two instances of
  an LSA, both having identical LS sequence numbers and LS checksums.
  An instance of age MaxAge is then always accepted as most recent;
  this allows old LSAs to be flushed quickly from the routing domain.
  Otherwise, if the ages differ by more than MaxAgeDiff, the instance
  having the smaller age is accepted as most recent.[12] See Section
  13.1 for more details.

12.1.2.  Options

  The Options field in the LSA header indicates which optional
  capabilities are associated with the LSA.  OSPF's optional
  capabilities are described in Section 4.5. One optional capability is
  defined by this specification, represented by the E-bit found in the
  Options field.  The unrecognized bits in the Options field should be
  set to zero.  The E-bit represents OSPF's ExternalRoutingCapability.
  This bit should be set in all LSAs associated with the backbone, and
  all LSAs associated with non-stub areas (see Section 3.6).  It should
  also be set in all AS-external-LSAs.  It should be reset in all
  router-LSAs, network-LSAs and summary-LSAs associated with a stub
  area.  For all LSAs, the setting of the E-bit is for informational
  purposes only; it does not affect the routing table calculation.









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 101]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


12.1.3.  LS type

  The LS type field dictates the format and function of the LSA.  LSAs
  of different types have different names (e.g., router-LSAs or
  network-LSAs).  All LSA types defined by this memo, except the AS-
  external-LSAs (LS type = 5), are flooded throughout a single area
  only.  AS-external-LSAs are flooded throughout the entire Autonomous
  System, excepting stub areas (see Section 3.6).  Each separate LSA
  type is briefly described below in Table 15.

12.1.4.  Link State ID

  This field identifies the piece of the routing domain that is being
  described by the LSA.  Depending on the LSA's LS type, the Link State
  ID takes on the values listed in Table 16.

  Actually, for Type 3 summary-LSAs (LS type = 3) and AS-external-LSAs
  (LS type = 5), the Link State ID may additionally have one or more of
  the destination network's "host" bits set. For example, when
  originating an AS-external-LSA for the network 10.0.0.0 with mask of
  255.0.0.0, the Link State ID can be set to anything in the range
  10.0.0.0 through 10.255.255.255 inclusive (although 10.0.0.0 should
  be used whenever possible). The freedom to set certain host bits
  allows a router to originate separate LSAs for two networks having
  the same address but different masks. See Appendix E for details.


























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 102]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


           LS Type   LSA description
           ________________________________________________
           1         These are the router-LSAs.
                     They describe the collected
                      states of the router's
                     interfaces. For more information,
                     consult Section 12.4.1.
           ________________________________________________
           2         These are the network-LSAs.
                     They describe the set of routers
                     attached to the network. For
                     more information, consult
                     Section 12.4.2.
           ________________________________________________
           3 or 4    These are the summary-LSAs.
                     They describe inter-area routes,
                     and enable the condensation of
                     routing information at area
                     borders. Originated by area border
                     routers, the Type 3 summary-LSAs
                     describe routes to networks while the
                     Type 4 summary-LSAs describe routes to
                     AS boundary routers.
           ________________________________________________
           5         These are the AS-external-LSAs.
                     Originated by AS boundary routers,
                     they describe routes
                     to destinations external to the
                     Autonomous System. A default route for
                     the Autonomous System can also be
                     described by an AS-external-LSA.

           Table 15: OSPF link state advertisements (LSAs).

           LS Type   Link State ID
           _______________________________________________
           1         The originating router's Router ID.
           2         The IP interface address of the
                     network's Designated Router.
           3         The destination network's IP address.
           4         The Router ID of the described AS
                     boundary router.
           5         The destination network's IP address.


                  Table 16: The LSA's Link State ID.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 103]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  When the LSA is describing a network (LS type = 2, 3 or 5), the
  network's IP address is easily derived by masking the Link State ID
  with the network/subnet mask contained in the body of the LSA.  When
  the LSA is describing a router (LS type = 1 or 4), the Link State ID
  is always the described router's OSPF Router ID.

  When an AS-external-LSA (LS Type = 5) is describing a default route,
  its Link State ID is set to DefaultDestination (0.0.0.0).

12.1.5.  Advertising Router

  This field specifies the OSPF Router ID of the LSA's originator.  For
  router-LSAs, this field is identical to the Link State ID field.
  Network-LSAs are originated by the network's Designated Router.
  Summary-LSAs originated by area border routers.  AS-external-LSAs are
  originated by AS boundary routers.

12.1.6.  LS sequence number


  The sequence number field is a signed 32-bit integer.  It is used to
  detect old and duplicate LSAs.  The space of sequence numbers is
  linearly ordered.  The larger the sequence number (when compared as
  signed 32-bit integers) the more recent the LSA.  To describe to
  sequence number space more precisely, let N refer in the discussion
  below to the constant 2**31.

  The sequence number -N (0x80000000) is reserved (and unused).  This
  leaves -N + 1 (0x80000001) as the smallest (and therefore oldest)
  sequence number; this sequence number is referred to as the constant
  InitialSequenceNumber. A router uses InitialSequenceNumber the first
  time it originates any LSA.  Afterwards, the LSA's sequence number is
  incremented each time the router originates a new instance of the
  LSA.  When an attempt is made to increment the sequence number past
  the maximum value of N - 1 (0x7fffffff; also referred to as
  MaxSequenceNumber), the current instance of the LSA must first be
  flushed from the routing domain.  This is done by prematurely aging
  the LSA (see Section 14.1) and reflooding it.  As soon as this flood
  has been acknowledged by all adjacent neighbors, a new instance can
  be originated with sequence number of InitialSequenceNumber.

  The router may be forced to promote the sequence number of one of its
  LSAs when a more recent instance of the LSA is unexpectedly received
  during the flooding process. This should be a rare event.  This may
  indicate that an out-of-date LSA, originated by the router itself
  before its last restart/reload, still exists in the Autonomous
  System.  For more information see Section 13.4.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 104]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


12.1.7.  LS checksum

  This field is the checksum of the complete contents of the LSA,
  excepting the LS age field.  The LS age field is excepted so that an
  LSA's age can be incremented without updating the checksum.  The
  checksum used is the same that is used for ISO connectionless
  datagrams; it is commonly referred to as the Fletcher checksum.  It
  is documented in Annex B of [Ref6]. The LSA header also contains the
  length of the LSA in bytes; subtracting the size of the LS age field
  (two bytes) yields the amount of data to checksum.

  The checksum is used to detect data corruption of an LSA.  This
  corruption can occur while an LSA is being flooded, or while it is
  being held in a router's memory.  The LS checksum field cannot take
  on the value of zero; the occurrence of such a value should be
  considered a checksum failure.  In other words, calculation of the
  checksum is not optional.

  The checksum of an LSA is verified in two cases: a) when it is
  received in a Link State Update Packet and b) at times during the
  aging of the link state database.  The detection of a checksum
  failure leads to separate actions in each case.  See Sections 13 and
  14 for more details.

  Whenever the LS sequence number field indicates that two instances of
  an LSA are the same, the LS checksum field is examined.  If there is
  a difference, the instance with the larger LS checksum is considered
  to be most recent.[13] See Section 13.1 for more details.

12.2.  The link state database

  A router has a separate link state database for every area to which
  it belongs. All routers belonging to the same area have identical
  link state databases for the area.

  The databases for each individual area are always dealt with
  separately.  The shortest path calculation is performed separately
  for each area (see Section 16).  Components of the area link-state
  database are flooded throughout the area only.  Finally, when an
  adjacency (belonging to Area A) is being brought up, only the
  database for Area A is synchronized between the two routers.

  The area database is composed of router-LSAs, network-LSAs and
  summary-LSAs (all listed in the area data structure).  In addition,
  external routes (AS-external-LSAs) are included in all non-stub area
  databases (see Section 3.6).





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 105]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  An implementation of OSPF must be able to access individual pieces of
  an area database.  This lookup function is based on an LSA's LS type,
  Link State ID and Advertising Router.[14] There will be a single
  instance (the most up-to-date) of each LSA in the database.  The
  database lookup function is invoked during the LSA flooding procedure
  (Section 13) and the routing table calculation (Section 16).  In
  addition, using this lookup function the router can determine whether
  it has itself ever originated a particular LSA, and if so, with what
  LS sequence number.

  An LSA is added to a router's database when either a) it is received
  during the flooding process (Section 13) or b) it is originated by
  the router itself (Section 12.4).  An LSA is deleted from a router's
  database when either a) it has been overwritten by a newer instance
  during the flooding process (Section 13) or b) the router originates
  a newer instance of one of its self-originated LSAs (Section 12.4) or
  c) the LSA ages out and is flushed from the routing domain (Section
  14).

  Whenever an LSA is deleted from the database it must also be removed
  from all neighbors' Link state retransmission lists (see Section 10).

12.3.  Representation of TOS

  For backward compatibility with previous versions of the OSPF
  specification ([Ref9]), TOS-specific information can be included in
  router-LSAs, summary-LSAs and AS-external-LSAs.  The encoding of TOS
  in OSPF LSAs is specified in Table 17. That table relates the OSPF
  encoding to the IP packet header's TOS field (defined in [Ref12]).
  The OSPF encoding is expressed as a decimal integer, and the IP
  packet header's TOS field is expressed in the binary TOS values used
  in [Ref12].



















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 106]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                   OSPF encoding   RFC 1349 TOS values
                   ___________________________________________
                   0               0000 normal service
                   2               0001 minimize monetary cost
                   4               0010 maximize reliability
                   6               0011
                   8               0100 maximize throughput
                   10              0101
                   12              0110
                   14              0111
                   16              1000 minimize delay
                   18              1001
                   20              1010
                   22              1011
                   24              1100
                   26              1101
                   28              1110
                   30              1111

                 Table 17: Representing TOS in OSPF.

12.4.  Originating LSAs

  Into any given OSPF area, a router will originate several LSAs.  Each
  router originates a router-LSA.  If the router is also the Designated
  Router for any of the area's networks, it will originate network-LSAs
  for those networks.

  Area border routers originate a single summary-LSA for each known
  inter-area destination.  AS boundary routers originate a single AS-
  external-LSA for each known AS external destination.  Destinations
  are advertised one at a time so that the change in any single route
  can be flooded without reflooding the entire collection of routes.
  During the flooding procedure, many LSAs can be carried by a single
  Link State Update packet.

  As an example, consider Router RT4 in Figure 6.  It is an area border
  router, having a connection to Area 1 and the backbone.  Router RT4
  originates 5 distinct LSAs into the backbone (one router-LSA, and one
  summary-LSA for each of the networks N1-N4).  Router RT4 will also
  originate 8 distinct LSAs into Area 1 (one router-LSA and seven
  summary-LSAs as pictured in Figure 7).  If RT4 has been selected as
  Designated Router for Network N3, it will also originate a network-
  LSA for N3 into Area 1.

  In this same figure, Router RT5 will be originating 3 distinct AS-
  external-LSAs (one for each of the networks N12-N14).  These will be
  flooded throughout the entire AS, assuming that none of the areas



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 107]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  have been configured as stubs.  However, if area 3 has been
  configured as a stub area, the AS-external-LSAs for networks N12-N14
  will not be flooded into area 3 (see Section 3.6).  Instead, Router
  RT11 would originate a default summary- LSA that would be flooded
  throughout area 3 (see Section 12.4.3).  This instructs all of area
  3's internal routers to send their AS external traffic to RT11.

  Whenever a new instance of an LSA is originated, its LS sequence
  number is incremented, its LS age is set to 0, its LS checksum is
  calculated, and the LSA is added to the link state database and
  flooded out the appropriate interfaces.  See Section 13.2 for details
  concerning the installation of the LSA into the link state database.
  See Section 13.3 for details concerning the flooding of newly
  originated LSAs.

  The ten events that can cause a new instance of an LSA to be
  originated are:

  (1) The LS age field of one of the router's self-originated LSAs
      reaches the value LSRefreshTime. In this case, a new
      instance of the LSA is originated, even though the contents
      of the LSA (apart from the LSA header) will be the same.
      This guarantees periodic originations of all LSAs.  This
      periodic updating of LSAs adds robustness to the link state
      algorithm.  LSAs that solely describe unreachable
      destinations should not be refreshed, but should instead be
      flushed from the routing domain (see Section 14.1).

  When whatever is being described by an LSA changes, a new LSA is
  originated.  However, two instances of the same LSA may not be
  originated within the time period MinLSInterval.  This may require
  that the generation of the next instance be delayed by up to
  MinLSInterval.  The following events may cause the contents of an LSA
  to change.  These events should cause new originations if and only if
  the contents of the new LSA would be different:

  (2) An interface's state changes (see Section 9.1).  This may
      mean that it is necessary to produce a new instance of the
      router-LSA.

  (3) An attached network's Designated Router changes.  A new
      router-LSA should be originated.  Also, if the router itself
      is now the Designated Router, a new network-LSA should be
      produced.  If the router itself is no longer the Designated
      Router, any network-LSA that it might have originated for
      the network should be flushed from the routing domain (see
      Section 14.1).




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 108]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (4) One of the neighboring routers changes to/from the FULL
      state.  This may mean that it is necessary to produce a new
      instance of the router-LSA.  Also, if the router is itself
      the Designated Router for the attached network, a new
      network-LSA should be produced.

  The next four events concern area border routers only:

  (5) An intra-area route has been added/deleted/modified in the
      routing table.  This may cause a new instance of a summary-
      LSA (for this route) to be originated in each attached area
      (possibly including the backbone).

  (6) An inter-area route has been added/deleted/modified in the
      routing table.  This may cause a new instance of a summary-
      LSA (for this route) to be originated in each attached area
      (but NEVER for the backbone).

  (7) The router becomes newly attached to an area.  The router
      must then originate summary-LSAs into the newly attached
      area for all pertinent intra-area and inter-area routes in
      the router's routing table.  See Section 12.4.3 for more
      details.

  (8) When the state of one of the router's configured virtual
      links changes, it may be necessary to originate a new
      router-LSA into the virtual link's Transit area (see the
      discussion of the router-LSA's bit V in Section 12.4.1), as
      well as originating a new router-LSA into the backbone.

  The last two events concern AS boundary routers (and former AS
  boundary routers) only:

  (9) An external route gained through direct experience with an
      external routing protocol (like BGP) changes.  This will
      cause an AS boundary router to originate a new instance of
      an AS-external-LSA.

  (10)
      A router ceases to be an AS boundary router, perhaps after
      restarting. In this situation the router should flush all
      AS-external-LSAs that it had previously originated.  These
      LSAs can be flushed via the premature aging procedure
      specified in Section 14.1.







Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 109]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The construction of each type of LSA is explained in detail below. In
  general, these sections describe the contents of the LSA body (i.e.,
  the part coming after the 20-byte LSA header).  For information
  concerning the building of the LSA header, see Section 12.1.

12.4.1.  Router-LSAs

  A router originates a router-LSA for each area that it belongs to.
  Such an LSA describes the collected states of the router's links to
  the area.  The LSA is flooded throughout the particular area, and no
  further.  The format of a router-LSA is shown in Appendix A (Section
  A.4.2).  The first 20 bytes of the LSA consist of the generic LSA
  header that was discussed in Section 12.1.  router-LSAs have LS type
  = 1.

  A router also indicates whether it is an area border router, or an AS
  boundary router, by setting the appropriate bits

                 ....................................
                 . 192.1.2                   Area 1 .
                 .     +                            .
                 .     |                            .
                 .     | 3+---+1                    .
                 .  N1 |--|RT1|-----+               .
                 .     |  +---+      \              .
                 .     |              \  _______N3  .
                 .     +               \/       \   .  1+---+
                 .                     * 192.1.1 *------|RT4|
                 .     +               /\_______/   .   +---+
                 .     |              /     |       .
                 .     | 3+---+1     /      |       .
                 .  N2 |--|RT2|-----+      1|       .
                 .     |  +---+           +---+8    .         6+---+
                 .     |                  |RT3|----------------|RT6|
                 .     +                  +---+     .          +---+
                 . 192.1.3                  |2      .   18.10.0.6|7
                 .                          |       .            |
                 .                   +------------+ .
                 .                     192.1.4 (N4) .
                 ....................................

              Figure 15: Area 1 with IP addresses shown

  (bit B and bit E, respectively) in its router-LSAs. This enables
  paths to those types of routers to be saved in the routing table, for
  later processing of summary-LSAs and AS-external-LSAs.  Bit B should
  be set whenever the router is actively attached to two or more areas,
  even if the router is not currently attached to the OSPF backbone



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 110]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  area.  Bit E should never be set in a router-LSA for a stub area
  (stub areas cannot contain AS boundary routers).

  In addition, the router sets bit V in its router-LSA for Area A if
  and only if the router is the endpoint of one or more fully adjacent
  virtual links having Area A as their Transit area. The setting of bit
  V enables other routers in Area A to discover whether the area
  supports transit traffic (see TransitCapability in Section 6).

  The router-LSA then describes the router's working connections (i.e.,
  interfaces or links) to the area.  Each link is typed according to
  the kind of attached network.  Each link is also labelled with its
  Link ID.  This Link ID gives a name to the entity that is on the
  other end of the link.  Table 18 summarizes the values used for the
  Type and Link ID fields.

          Link type   Description       Link ID
          __________________________________________________
          1           Point-to-point    Neighbor Router ID
                      link
          2           Link to transit   Interface address of
                      network           Designated Router
          3           Link to stub      IP network number
                      network
          4           Virtual link      Neighbor Router ID

                  Table 18: Link descriptions in the
                             router-LSA.

  In addition, the Link Data field is specified for each link.  This
  field gives 32 bits of extra information for the link.  For links to
  transit networks, numbered point-to-point links and virtual links,
  this field specifies the IP interface address of the associated
  router interface (this is needed by the routing table calculation,
  see Section 16.1.1).  For links to stub networks, this field
  specifies the stub network's IP address mask. For unnumbered point-
  to-point links, the Link Data field should be set to the unnumbered
  interface's MIB-II [Ref8] ifIndex value.

  Finally, the cost of using the link for output is specified.  The
  output cost of a link is configurable. With the exception of links to
  stub networks, the output cost must always be non-zero.

  To further describe the process of building the list of link
  descriptions, suppose a router wishes to build a router-LSA for Area
  A.  The router examines its collection of interface data structures.
  For each interface, the following steps are taken:




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 111]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  o    If the attached network does not belong to Area A, no
      links are added to the LSA, and the next interface should be
      examined.

  o    If the state of the interface is Down, no links are added.

  o    If the state of the interface is Loopback, add a Type 3
      link (stub network) as long as this is not an interface to an
      unnumbered point-to-point network.  The Link ID should be set to
      the IP interface address, the Link Data set to the
      mask 0xffffffff (indicating a host route), and the cost set to 0.

  o   Otherwise, the link descriptions added to the router-LSA
      depend on the OSPF interface type. Link descriptions used for
      point-to-point interfaces are specified in Section 12.4.1.1, for
      virtual links in Section 12.4.1.2, for broadcast and NBMA
      interfaces in 12.4.1.3, and for Point-to-MultiPoint interfaces in
      12.4.1.4.

  After consideration of all the router interfaces, host links are
  added to the router-LSA by examining the list of attached hosts
  belonging to Area A.  A host route is represented as a Type 3 link
  (stub network) whose Link ID is the host's IP address, Link Data is
  the mask of all ones (0xffffffff), and cost the host's configured
  cost (see Section C.7).

12.4.1.1.  Describing point-to-point interfaces

  For point-to-point interfaces, one or more link descriptions are
  added to the router-LSA as follows:

  o   If the neighboring router is fully adjacent, add a
      Type 1 link (point-to-point). The Link ID should be set to the
      Router ID of the neighboring router. For numbered point-to-point
      networks, the Link Data should specify the IP interface address.
      For unnumbered point-to-point networks, the Link Data field
      should specify the interface's MIB-II [Ref8] ifIndex value. The
      cost should be set to the output cost of the point-to-point
      interface.

  o   In addition, as long as the state of the interface
      is "Point-to-Point" (and regardless of the neighboring router
      state), a Type 3 link (stub network) should be added. There are
      two forms that this stub link can take:







Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 112]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Option 1
     Assuming that the neighboring router's IP address is known, set
     the Link ID of the Type 3 link to the neighbor's IP address, the
     Link Data to the mask 0xffffffff (indicating a host route), and
     the cost to the interface's configured output cost.[15]

  Option 2
     If a subnet has been assigned to the point-to-point link, set the
     Link ID of the Type 3 link to the subnet's IP address, the Link
     Data to the subnet's mask, and the cost to the interface's
     configured output cost.[16]

12.4.1.2.  Describing broadcast and NBMA interfaces

  For operational broadcast and NBMA interfaces, a single link
  description is added to the router-LSA as follows:

  o   If the state of the interface is Waiting, add a Type
      3 link (stub network) with Link ID set to the IP network number
      of the attached network, Link Data set to the attached network's
      address mask, and cost equal to the interface's configured output
      cost.

  o   Else, there has been a Designated Router elected for
      the attached network.  If the router is fully adjacent to the
      Designated Router, or if the router itself is Designated Router
      and is fully adjacent to at least one other router, add a single
      Type 2 link (transit network) with Link ID set to the IP
      interface address of the attached network's Designated Router
      (which may be the router itself), Link Data set to the router's
      own IP interface address, and cost equal to the interface's
      configured output cost.  Otherwise, add a link as if the
      interface state were Waiting (see above).

12.4.1.3.  Describing virtual links

  For virtual links, a link description is added to the router-LSA only
  when the virtual neighbor is fully adjacent. In this case, add a Type
  4 link (virtual link) with Link ID set to the Router ID of the
  virtual neighbor, Link Data set to the IP interface address
  associated with the virtual link and cost set to the cost calculated
  for the virtual link during the routing table calculation (see
  Section 15).








Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 113]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


12.4.1.4.  Describing Point-to-MultiPoint interfaces

  For operational Point-to-MultiPoint interfaces, one or more link
  descriptions are added to the router-LSA as follows:

  o   A single Type 3 link (stub network) is added with
      Link ID set to the router's own IP interface address, Link Data
      set to the mask 0xffffffff (indicating a host route), and cost
      set to 0.

  o   For each fully adjacent neighbor associated with the
      interface, add an additional Type 1 link (point-to-point) with
      Link ID set to the Router ID of the neighboring router, Link Data
      set to the IP interface address and cost equal to the interface's
      configured output cost.

12.4.1.5.  Examples of router-LSAs

  Consider the router-LSAs generated by Router RT3, as pictured in
  Figure 6.  The area containing Router RT3 (Area 1) has been redrawn,
  with actual network addresses, in Figure 15.  Assume that the last
  byte of all of RT3's interface addresses is 3, giving it the
  interface addresses 192.1.1.3 and 192.1.4.3, and that the other
  routers have similar addressing schemes.  In addition, assume that
  all links are functional, and that Router IDs are assigned as the
  smallest IP interface address.

  RT3 originates two router-LSAs, one for Area 1 and one for the
  backbone.  Assume that Router RT4 has been selected as the Designated
  router for network 192.1.1.0.  RT3's router-LSA for Area 1 is then
  shown below.  It indicates that RT3 has two connections to Area 1,
  the first a link to the transit network 192.1.1.0 and the second a
  link to the stub network 192.1.4.0.  Note that the transit network is
  identified by the IP interface of its Designated Router (i.e., the
  Link ID = 192.1.1.4 which is the Designated Router RT4's IP interface
  to 192.1.1.0).  Note also that RT3 has indicated that it is an area
  border router.














Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 114]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


    ; RT3's router-LSA for Area 1

    LS age = 0                     ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)              ;
    LS type = 1                    ;indicates router-LSA
    Link State ID = 192.1.1.3      ;RT3's Router ID
    Advertising Router = 192.1.1.3 ;RT3's Router ID
    bit E = 0                      ;not an AS boundary router
    bit B = 1                      ;area border router
    #links = 2
           Link ID = 192.1.1.4     ;IP address of Desig. Rtr.
           Link Data = 192.1.1.3   ;RT3's IP interface to net
           Type = 2                ;connects to transit network
           # TOS metrics = 0
           metric = 1

           Link ID = 192.1.4.0     ;IP Network number
           Link Data = 0xffffff00  ;Network mask
           Type = 3                ;connects to stub network
           # TOS metrics = 0
           metric = 2

  Next RT3's router-LSA for the backbone is shown.  It indicates that
  RT3 has a single attachment to the backbone.  This attachment is via
  an unnumbered point-to-point link to Router RT6.  RT3 has again
  indicated that it is an area border router.


    ; RT3's router-LSA for the backbone

    LS age = 0                     ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)              ;
    LS type = 1                    ;indicates router-LSA
    Link State ID = 192.1.1.3      ;RT3's router ID
    Advertising Router = 192.1.1.3 ;RT3's router ID
    bit E = 0                      ;not an AS boundary router
    bit B = 1                      ;area border router
    #links = 1
           Link ID = 18.10.0.6     ;Neighbor's Router ID
           Link Data = 0.0.0.3     ;MIB-II ifIndex of P-P link
           Type = 1                ;connects to router
           # TOS metrics = 0
           metric = 8








Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 115]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


12.4.2.  Network-LSAs

  A network-LSA is generated for every transit broadcast or NBMA
  network.  (A transit network is a network having two or more attached
  routers).  The network-LSA describes all the routers that are
  attached to the network.

  The Designated Router for the network originates the LSA.  The
  Designated Router originates the LSA only if it is fully adjacent to
  at least one other router on the network.  The network-LSA is flooded
  throughout the area that contains the transit network, and no
  further.  The network-LSA lists those routers that are fully adjacent
  to the Designated Router; each fully adjacent router is identified by
  its OSPF Router ID. The Designated Router includes itself in this
  list.

  The Link State ID for a network-LSA is the IP interface address of
  the Designated Router.  This value, masked by the network's address
  mask (which is also contained in the network-LSA) yields the
  network's IP address.

  A router that has formerly been the Designated Router for a network,
  but is no longer, should flush the network-LSA that it had previously
  originated.  This LSA is no longer used in the routing table
  calculation.  It is flushed by prematurely incrementing the LSA's age
  to MaxAge and reflooding (see Section 14.1). In addition, in those
  rare cases where a router's Router ID has changed, any network-LSAs
  that were originated with the router's previous Router ID must be
  flushed. Since the router may have no idea what it's previous Router
  ID might have been, these network-LSAs are indicated by having their
  Link State ID equal to one of the router's IP interface addresses and
  their Advertising Router equal to some value other than the router's
  current Router ID (see Section 13.4 for more details).

12.4.2.1.  Examples of network-LSAs

  Again consider the area configuration in Figure 6.  Network-LSAs are
  originated for Network N3 in Area 1, Networks N6 and N8 in Area 2,
  and Network N9 in Area 3.  Assuming that Router RT4 has been selected
  as the Designated Router for Network N3, the following network-LSA is
  generated by RT4 on behalf of Network N3 (see Figure 15 for the
  address assignments):









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 116]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


    ; Network-LSA for Network N3

    LS age = 0                     ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)              ;
    LS type = 2                    ;indicates network-LSA
    Link State ID = 192.1.1.4      ;IP address of Desig. Rtr.
    Advertising Router = 192.1.1.4 ;RT4's Router ID
    Network Mask = 0xffffff00
           Attached Router = 192.1.1.4    ;Router ID
           Attached Router = 192.1.1.1    ;Router ID
           Attached Router = 192.1.1.2    ;Router ID
           Attached Router = 192.1.1.3    ;Router ID

12.4.3.  Summary-LSAs

  The destination described by a summary-LSA is either an IP network,
  an AS boundary router or a range of IP addresses.  Summary-LSAs are
  flooded throughout a single area only.  The destination described is
  one that is external to the area, yet still belongs to the Autonomous
  System.

  Summary-LSAs are originated by area border routers.  The precise
  summary routes to advertise into an area are determined by examining
  the routing table structure (see Section 11) in accordance with the
  algorithm described below. Note that only intra-area routes are
  advertised into the backbone, while both intra-area and inter-area
  routes are advertised into the other areas.

  To determine which routes to advertise into an attached Area A, each
  routing table entry is processed as follows.  Remember that each
  routing table entry describes a set of equal-cost best paths to a
  particular destination:

  o  Only Destination Types of network and AS boundary router
     are advertised in summary-LSAs.  If the routing table entry's
     Destination Type is area border router, examine the next routing
     table entry.

  o  AS external routes are never advertised in summary-LSAs.
     If the routing table entry has Path-type of type 1 external or
     type 2 external, examine the next routing table entry.

  o  Else, if the area associated with this set of paths is
     the Area A itself, do not generate a summary-LSA for the
     route.[17]






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 117]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  o  Else, if the next hops associated with this set of paths
     belong to Area A itself, do not generate a summary-LSA for the
     route.[18] This is the logical equivalent of a Distance Vector
     protocol's split horizon logic.

  o  Else, if the routing table cost equals or exceeds the
     value LSInfinity, a summary-LSA cannot be generated for this
     route.

  o  Else, if the destination of this route is an AS boundary
     router, a summary-LSA should be originated if and only if the
     routing table entry describes the preferred path to the AS
     boundary router (see Step 3 of Section 16.4).  If so, a Type 4
     summary-LSA is originated for the destination, with Link State ID
     equal to the AS boundary router's Router ID and metric equal to
     the routing table entry's cost. Note: these LSAs should not be
     generated if Area A has been configured as a stub area.

  o  Else, the Destination type is network. If this is an
     inter-area route, generate a Type 3 summary-LSA for the
     destination, with Link State ID equal to the network's address (if
     necessary, the Link State ID can also have one or more of the
     network's host bits set; see Appendix E for details) and metric
     equal to the routing table cost.

  o  The one remaining case is an intra-area route to a network.  This
     means that the network is contained in one of the router's
     directly attached areas.  In general, this information must be
     condensed before appearing in summary-LSAs.  Remember that an area
     has a configured list of address ranges, each range consisting of
     an [address,mask] pair and a status indication of either Advertise
     or DoNotAdvertise.  At most a single Type 3 summary-LSA is
     originated for each range. When the range's status indicates
     Advertise, a Type 3 summary-LSA is generated with Link State ID
     equal to the range's address (if necessary, the Link State ID can
     also have one or more of the range's "host" bits set; see Appendix
     E for details) and cost equal to the largest cost of any of the
     component networks. When the range's status indicates
     DoNotAdvertise, the Type 3 summary-LSA is suppressed and the
     component networks remain hidden from other areas.

  By default, if a network is not contained in any explicitly
  configured address range, a Type 3 summary-LSA is generated with Link
  State ID equal to the network's address (if necessary, the Link State
  ID can also have one or more of the network's "host" bits set; see
  Appendix E for details) and metric equal to the network's routing
  table cost.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 118]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  If an area is capable of carrying transit traffic (i.e., its
  TransitCapability is set to TRUE), routing information concerning
  backbone networks should not be condensed before being summarized
  into the area.  Nor should the advertisement of backbone networks
  into transit areas be suppressed.  In other words, the backbone's
  configured ranges should be ignored when originating summary-LSAs
  into transit areas.

  If a router advertises a summary-LSA for a destination which then
  becomes unreachable, the router must then flush the LSA from the
  routing domain by setting its age to MaxAge and reflooding (see
  Section 14.1).  Also, if the destination is still reachable, yet can
  no longer be advertised according to the above procedure (e.g., it is
  now an inter-area route, when it used to be an intra-area route
  associated with some non-backbone area; it would thus no longer be
  advertisable to the backbone), the LSA should also be flushed from
  the routing domain.

12.4.3.1.  Originating summary-LSAs into stub areas

  The algorithm in Section 12.4.3 is optional when Area A is an OSPF
  stub area. Area border routers connecting to a stub area can
  originate summary-LSAs into the area according to the Section
  12.4.3's algorithm, or can choose to originate only a subset of the
  summary-LSAs, possibly under configuration control.  The fewer LSAs
  originated, the smaller the stub area's link state database, further
  reducing the demands on its routers' resources. However, omitting
  LSAs may also lead to sub-optimal inter-area routing, although
  routing will continue to function.

  As specified in Section 12.4.3, Type 4 summary-LSAs (ASBR-summary-
  LSAs) are never originated into stub areas.

  In a stub area, instead of importing external routes each area border
  router originates a "default summary-LSA" into the area. The Link
  State ID for the default summary-LSA is set to DefaultDestination,
  and the metric set to the (per-area) configurable parameter
  StubDefaultCost.  Note that StubDefaultCost need not be configured
  identically in all of the stub area's area border routers.

12.4.3.2.  Examples of summary-LSAs

  Consider again the area configuration in Figure 6.  Routers RT3, RT4,
  RT7, RT10 and RT11 are all area border routers, and therefore are
  originating summary-LSAs.  Consider in particular Router RT4.  Its
  routing table was calculated as the example in Section 11.3. RT4
  originates summary-LSAs into both the backbone and Area 1.  Into the
  backbone, Router RT4 originates separate LSAs for each of the



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 119]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  networks N1-N4.  Into Area 1, Router RT4 originates separate LSAs for
  networks N6-N8 and the AS boundary routers RT5,RT7.  It also
  condenses host routes Ia and Ib into a single summary-LSA.  Finally,
  the routes to networks N9,N10,N11 and Host H1 are advertised by a
  single summary-LSA.  This condensation was originally performed by
  the router RT11.

  These LSAs are illustrated graphically in Figures 7 and 8.  Two of
  the summary-LSAs originated by Router RT4 follow.  The actual IP
  addresses for the networks and routers in question have been assigned
  in Figure 15.

    ; Summary-LSA for Network N1,
    ; originated by Router RT4 into the backbone

    LS age = 0                  ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)           ;
    LS type = 3                 ;Type 3 summary-LSA
    Link State ID = 192.1.2.0   ;N1's IP network number
    Advertising Router = 192.1.1.4       ;RT4's ID
    metric = 4

    ; Summary-LSA for AS boundary router RT7
    ; originated by Router RT4 into Area 1

    LS age = 0                  ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)           ;
    LS type = 4                 ;Type 4 summary-LSA
    Link State ID = Router RT7's ID
    Advertising Router = 192.1.1.4       ;RT4's ID
    metric = 14

12.4.4.  AS-external-LSAs

  AS-external-LSAs describe routes to destinations external to the
  Autonomous System.  Most AS-external-LSAs describe routes to specific
  external destinations; in these cases the LSA's Link State ID is set
  to the destination network's IP address (if necessary, the Link State
  ID can also have one or more of the network's "host" bits set; see
  Appendix E for details).  However, a default route for the Autonomous
  System can be described in an AS-external-LSA by setting the LSA's
  Link State ID to DefaultDestination (0.0.0.0).  AS-external-LSAs are
  originated by AS boundary routers.  An AS boundary router originates
  a single AS-external-LSA for each external route that it has learned,
  either through another routing protocol (such as BGP), or through
  configuration information.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 120]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  AS-external-LSAs are the only type of LSAs that are flooded
  throughout the entire Autonomous System; all other types of LSAs are
  specific to a single area.  However, AS-external-LSAs are not flooded
  into/throughout stub areas (see Section 3.6).  This enables a
  reduction in link state database size for routers internal to stub
  areas.

  The metric that is advertised for an external route can be one of two
  types.  Type 1 metrics are comparable to the link state metric.  Type
  2 metrics are assumed to be larger than the cost of any intra-AS
  path.

  If a router advertises an AS-external-LSA for a destination which
  then becomes unreachable, the router must then flush the LSA from the
  routing domain by setting its age to MaxAge and reflooding (see
  Section 14.1).

12.4.4.1.  Examples of AS-external-LSAs

  Consider once again the AS pictured in Figure 6.  There are two AS
  boundary routers: RT5 and RT7.  Router RT5 originates three AS-
  external-LSAs, for networks N12-N14.  Router RT7 originates two AS-
  external-LSAs, for networks N12 and N15.  Assume that RT7 has learned
  its route to N12 via BGP, and that it wishes to advertise a Type 2
  metric to the AS.  RT7 would then originate the following LSA for
  N12:

    ; AS-external-LSA for Network N12,
    ; originated by Router RT7

    LS age = 0                  ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)           ;
    LS type = 5                 ;AS-external-LSA
    Link State ID = N12's IP network number
    Advertising Router = Router RT7's ID
    bit E = 1                   ;Type 2 metric
    metric = 2
    Forwarding address = 0.0.0.0

  In the above example, the forwarding address field has been set to
  0.0.0.0, indicating that packets for the external destination should
  be forwarded to the advertising OSPF router (RT7). This is not always
  desirable.  Consider the example pictured in Figure 16.  There are
  three OSPF routers (RTA, RTB and RTC) connected to a common network.
  Only one of these routers, RTA, is exchanging BGP information with
  the non-OSPF router RTX.  RTA must then originate AS- external-LSAs
  for those destinations it has learned from RTX.  By using the AS-
  external-LSA's forwarding address field, RTA can specify that packets



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 121]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  for these destinations be forwarded directly to RTX.  Without this
  feature, Routers RTB and RTC would take an extra hop to get to these
  destinations.

  Note that when the forwarding address field is non-zero, it should
  point to a router belonging to another Autonomous System.

  A forwarding address can also be specified for the default route. For
  example, in figure 16 RTA may want to specify that all externally-
  destined packets should by default be forwarded to its BGP peer RTX.
  The resulting AS-external-LSA is pictured below.  Note that the Link
  State ID is set to DefaultDestination.

    ; Default route, originated by Router RTA
    ; Packets forwarded through RTX

    LS age = 0                  ;always true on origination
    Options = (E-bit)           ;
    LS type = 5                 ;AS-external-LSA
    Link State ID = DefaultDestination  ; default route
    Advertising Router = Router RTA's ID
    bit E = 1                   ;Type 2 metric
    metric = 1
    Forwarding address = RTX's IP address

  In figure 16, suppose instead that both RTA and RTB exchange BGP
  information with RTX.  In this case, RTA and RTB would originate the
  same set of AS-external-LSAs.  These LSAs, if they specify the same
  metric, would be functionally equivalent since they would specify the
  same destination and forwarding address (RTX). This leads to a clear
  duplication of effort.  If only one of RTA or RTB originated the set
  of AS-external-LSAs, the routing would remain the same, and the size
  of the link state database would decrease.  However, it must be
  unambiguously defined as to which router originates the LSAs
  (otherwise neither may, or the identity of the originator may
  oscillate). The following rule is thereby established: if two
  routers, both reachable from one another, originate functionally
  equivalent AS-external-LSAs (i.e., same destination, cost and non-
  zero forwarding address), then the LSA originated by the router
  having the highest OSPF Router ID is used.  The router having the
  lower OSPF Router ID can then flush its LSA.  Flushing an LSA is
  discussed in Section 14.1.

13.  The Flooding Procedure

  Link State Update packets provide the mechanism for flooding LSAs.  A
  Link State Update packet may contain several distinct LSAs, and
  floods each LSA one hop further from its point of origination.  To



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 122]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  make the flooding procedure reliable, each LSA must be acknowledged
  separately.  Acknowledgments are transmitted in Link State
  Acknowledgment packets.  Many separate acknowledgments can also be
  grouped together into a single packet.

  The flooding procedure starts when a Link State Update packet has
  been received.  Many consistency checks have been made on the
  received packet before being handed to the flooding procedure (see
  Section 8.2).  In particular, the Link State Update packet has been
  associated with a particular neighbor, and a particular area.  If the
  neighbor is in a lesser state than Exchange, the packet should be
  dropped without further processing.

                               +
                               |
                     +---+.....|.BGP
                     |RTA|-----|.....+---+
                     +---+     |-----|RTX|
                               |     +---+
                     +---+     |
                     |RTB|-----|
                     +---+     |
                               |
                     +---+     |
                     |RTC|-----|
                     +---+     |
                               |
                               +

                Figure 16: Forwarding address example

  All types of LSAs, other than AS-external-LSAs, are associated with a
  specific area.  However, LSAs do not contain an area field.  An LSA's
  area must be deduced from the Link State Update packet header.

  For each LSA contained in a Link State Update packet, the following
  steps are taken:


   (1) Validate the LSA's LS checksum.  If the checksum turns out to be
       invalid, discard the LSA and get the next one from the Link
       State Update packet.

   (2) Examine the LSA's LS type.  If the LS type is unknown, discard
       the LSA and get the next one from the Link State Update Packet.
       This specification defines LS types 1-5 (see Section 4.3).

   (3) Else if this is an AS-external-LSA (LS type = 5), and the area



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 123]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


       has been configured as a stub area, discard the LSA and get the
       next one from the Link State Update Packet.  AS-external-LSAs
       are not flooded into/throughout stub areas (see Section 3.6).

   (4) Else if the LSA's LS age is equal to MaxAge, and there is
       currently no instance of the LSA in the router's link state
       database, then take the following actions:

       (a) Acknowledge the receipt of the LSA by sending a Link State
           Acknowledgment packet back to the sending neighbor (see
           Section 13.5).

       (b) Purge all outstanding requests for equal or previous
           instances of the LSA from the sending neighbor's Link State
           Request list (see Section 10).

       (c) If the sending neighbor is in state Exchange or in state
           Loading, then install the MaxAge LSA in the link state
           database.  Otherwise, simply discard the LSA.  In either
           case, examine the next LSA (if any) listed in the Link State
           Update packet.

   (5) Otherwise, find the instance of this LSA that is currently
       contained in the router's link state database.  If there is no
       database copy, or the received LSA is more recent than the
       database copy (see Section 13.1 below for the determination of
       which LSA is more recent) the following steps must be performed:

       (a) If there is already a database copy, and if the database
           copy was installed less than MinLSArrival seconds ago,
           discard the new LSA (without acknowledging it) and examine
           the next LSA (if any) listed in the Link State Update
           packet.

       (b) Otherwise immediately flood the new LSA out some subset of
           the router's interfaces (see Section 13.3).  In some cases
           (e.g., the state of the receiving interface is DR and the
           LSA was received from a router other than the Backup DR) the
           LSA will be flooded back out the receiving interface.  This
           occurrence should be noted for later use by the
           acknowledgment process (Section 13.5).

       (c) Remove the current database copy from all neighbors' Link
           state retransmission lists.

       (d) Install the new LSA in the link state database (replacing
           the current database copy).  This may cause the routing
           table calculation to be scheduled.  In addition, timestamp



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 124]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


           the new LSA with the current time (i.e., the time it was
           received).  The flooding procedure cannot overwrite the
           newly installed LSA until MinLSArrival seconds have elapsed.
           The LSA installation process is discussed further in Section
           13.2.

       (e) Possibly acknowledge the receipt of the LSA by sending a
           Link State Acknowledgment packet back out the receiving
           interface.  This is explained below in Section 13.5.

       (f) If this new LSA indicates that it was originated by the
           receiving router itself (i.e., is considered a self-
           originated LSA), the router must take special action, either
           updating the LSA or in some cases flushing it from the
           routing domain. For a description of how self-originated
           LSAs are detected and subsequently handled, see Section
           13.4.

   (6) Else, if there is an instance of the LSA on the sending
       neighbor's Link state request list, an error has occurred in the
       Database Exchange process.  In this case, restart the Database
       Exchange process by generating the neighbor event BadLSReq for
       the sending neighbor and stop processing the Link State Update
       packet.

   (7) Else, if the received LSA is the same instance as the database
       copy (i.e., neither one is more recent) the following two steps
       should be performed:

       (a) If the LSA is listed in the Link state retransmission list
           for the receiving adjacency, the router itself is expecting
           an acknowledgment for this LSA.  The router should treat the
           received LSA as an acknowledgment by removing the LSA from
           the Link state retransmission list.  This is termed an
           "implied acknowledgment".  Its occurrence should be noted
           for later use by the acknowledgment process (Section 13.5).

       (b) Possibly acknowledge the receipt of the LSA by sending a
           Link State Acknowledgment packet back out the receiving
           interface.  This is explained below in Section 13.5.

   (8) Else, the database copy is more recent.  If the database copy
       has LS age equal to MaxAge and LS sequence number equal to
       MaxSequenceNumber, simply discard the received LSA without
       acknowledging it. (In this case, the LSA's LS sequence number is
       wrapping, and the MaxSequenceNumber LSA must be completely
       flushed before any new LSA instance can be introduced).
       Otherwise, send the database copy back to the sending neighbor,



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 125]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


       encapsulated within a Link State Update Packet. The Link State
       Update Packet should be unicast to the neighbor. In so doing, do
       not put the database copy of the LSA on the neighbor's link
       state retransmission list, and do not acknowledge the received
       (less recent) LSA instance.

13.1.  Determining which LSA is newer

  When a router encounters two instances of an LSA, it must determine
  which is more recent.  This occurred above when comparing a received
  LSA to its database copy. This comparison must also be done during
  the Database Exchange procedure which occurs during adjacency bring-
  up.

  An LSA is identified by its LS type, Link State ID and Advertising
  Router.  For two instances of the same LSA, the LS sequence number,
  LS age, and LS checksum fields are used to determine which instance
  is more recent:

  o   The LSA having the newer LS sequence number is more recent.
      See Section 12.1.6 for an explanation of the LS sequence number
      space.  If both instances have the same LS sequence number, then:

  o   If the two instances have different LS checksums, then the
      instance having the larger LS checksum (when considered as a 16-
      bit unsigned integer) is considered more recent.

  o   Else, if only one of the instances has its LS age field set
      to MaxAge, the instance of age MaxAge is considered to be more
      recent.

  o   Else, if the LS age fields of the two instances differ by
      more than MaxAgeDiff, the instance having the smaller (younger)
      LS age is considered to be more recent.

  o   Else, the two instances are considered to be identical.















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 126]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


13.2.  Installing LSAs in the database

  Installing a new LSA in the database, either as the result of
  flooding or a newly self-originated LSA, may cause the OSPF routing
  table structure to be recalculated.  The contents of the new LSA
  should be compared to the old instance, if present.  If there is no
  difference, there is no need to recalculate the routing table. When
  comparing an LSA to its previous instance, the following are all
  considered to be differences in contents:

  o   The LSA's Options field has changed.

  o   One of the LSA instances has LS age set to MaxAge, and
      the other does not.

  o   The length field in the LSA header has changed.

  o   The body of the LSA (i.e., anything outside the 20-byte
      LSA header) has changed. Note that this excludes changes in LS
      Sequence Number and LS Checksum.

  If the contents are different, the following pieces of the routing
  table must be recalculated, depending on the new LSA's LS type field:

  Router-LSAs and network-LSAs
     The entire routing table must be recalculated, starting with the
     shortest path calculations for each area (not just the area whose
     link-state database has changed).  The reason that the shortest
     path calculation cannot be restricted to the single changed area
     has to do with the fact that AS boundary routers may belong to
     multiple areas.  A change in the area currently providing the best
     route may force the router to use an intra-area route provided by
     a different area.[19]

  Summary-LSAs
     The best route to the destination described by the summary-LSA
     must be recalculated (see Section 16.5).  If this destination is
     an AS boundary router, it may also be necessary to re-examine all
     the AS-external-LSAs.

  AS-external-LSAs
     The best route to the destination described by the AS-external-LSA
     must be recalculated (see Section 16.6).

     Also, any old instance of the LSA must be removed from the
     database when the new LSA is installed.  This old instance must
     also be removed from all neighbors' Link state retransmission
     lists (see Section 10).



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 127]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


13.3.  Next step in the flooding procedure

  When a new (and more recent) LSA has been received, it must be
  flooded out some set of the router's interfaces.  This section
  describes the second part of flooding procedure (the first part being
  the processing that occurred in Section 13), namely, selecting the
  outgoing interfaces and adding the LSA to the appropriate neighbors'
  Link state retransmission lists.  Also included in this part of the
  flooding procedure is the maintenance of the neighbors' Link state
  request lists.

  This section is equally applicable to the flooding of an LSA that the
  router itself has just originated (see Section 12.4).

  For these LSAs, this section provides the entirety of the flooding
  procedure (i.e., the processing of Section 13 is not performed,
  since, for example, the LSA has not been received from a neighbor and
  therefore does not need to be acknowledged).

  Depending upon the LSA's LS type, the LSA can be flooded out only
  certain interfaces.  These interfaces, defined by the following, are
  called the eligible interfaces:

  AS-external-LSAs (LS Type = 5)
     AS-external-LSAs are flooded throughout the entire AS, with the
     exception of stub areas (see Section 3.6).  The eligible
     interfaces are all the router's interfaces, excluding virtual
     links and those interfaces attaching to stub areas.

  All other LS types
     All other types are specific to a single area (Area A).  The
     eligible interfaces are all those interfaces attaching to the Area
     A.  If Area A is the backbone, this includes all the virtual
     links.

  Link state databases must remain synchronized over all adjacencies
  associated with the above eligible interfaces.  This is accomplished
  by executing the following steps on each eligible interface.  It
  should be noted that this procedure may decide not to flood an LSA
  out a particular interface, if there is a high probability that the
  attached neighbors have already received the LSA.  However, in these
  cases the flooding procedure must be absolutely sure that the
  neighbors eventually do receive the LSA, so the LSA is still added to
  each adjacency's Link state retransmission list.  For each eligible
  interface:






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 128]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (1) Each of the neighbors attached to this interface are
      examined, to determine whether they must receive the new
      LSA.  The following steps are executed for each neighbor:

      (a) If the neighbor is in a lesser state than Exchange, it
          does not participate in flooding, and the next neighbor
          should be examined.

      (b) Else, if the adjacency is not yet full (neighbor state
          is Exchange or Loading), examine the Link state request
          list associated with this adjacency.  If there is an
          instance of the new LSA on the list, it indicates that
          the neighboring router has an instance of the LSA
          already.  Compare the new LSA to the neighbor's copy:

          o   If the new LSA is less recent, then examine the next
              neighbor.

          o   If the two copies are the same instance, then delete
              the LSA from the Link state request list, and
              examine the next neighbor.[20]

          o   Else, the new LSA is more recent.  Delete the LSA
              from the Link state request list.

      (c) If the new LSA was received from this neighbor, examine
          the next neighbor.

      (d) At this point we are not positive that the neighbor has
          an up-to-date instance of this new LSA.  Add the new LSA
          to the Link state retransmission list for the adjacency.
          This ensures that the flooding procedure is reliable;
          the LSA will be retransmitted at intervals until an
          acknowledgment is seen from the neighbor.

  (2) The router must now decide whether to flood the new LSA out
      this interface.  If in the previous step, the LSA was NOT
      added to any of the Link state retransmission lists, there
      is no need to flood the LSA out the interface and the next
      interface should be examined.

  (3) If the new LSA was received on this interface, and it was
      received from either the Designated Router or the Backup
      Designated Router, chances are that all the neighbors have
      received the LSA already.  Therefore, examine the next
      interface.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 129]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (4) If the new LSA was received on this interface, and the
      interface state is Backup (i.e., the router itself is the
      Backup Designated Router), examine the next interface.  The
      Designated Router will do the flooding on this interface.
      However, if the Designated Router fails the router (i.e.,
      the Backup Designated Router) will end up retransmitting the
      updates.

  (5) If this step is reached, the LSA must be flooded out the
      interface.  Send a Link State Update packet (including the
      new LSA as contents) out the interface.  The LSA's LS age
      must be incremented by InfTransDelay (which must be > 0)
      when it is copied into the outgoing Link State Update packet
      (until the LS age field reaches the maximum value of
      MaxAge).

      On broadcast networks, the Link State Update packets are
      multicast.  The destination IP address specified for the
      Link State Update Packet depends on the state of the
      interface.  If the interface state is DR or Backup, the
      address AllSPFRouters should be used.  Otherwise, the
      address AllDRouters should be used.

      On non-broadcast networks, separate Link State Update
      packets must be sent, as unicasts, to each adjacent neighbor
      (i.e., those in state Exchange or greater).  The destination
      IP addresses for these packets are the neighbors' IP
      addresses.

13.4.  Receiving self-originated LSAs

  It is a common occurrence for a router to receive self-originated
  LSAs via the flooding procedure. A self-originated LSA is detected
  when either 1) the LSA's Advertising Router is equal to the router's
  own Router ID or 2) the LSA is a network-LSA and its Link State ID is
  equal to one of the router's own IP interface addresses.

  However, if the received self-originated LSA is newer than the last
  instance that the router actually originated, the router must take
  special action.  The reception of such an LSA indicates that there
  are LSAs in the routing domain that were originated by the router
  before the last time it was restarted.  In most cases, the router
  must then advance the LSA's LS sequence number one past the received
  LS sequence number, and originate a new instance of the LSA.

  It may be the case the router no longer wishes to originate the
  received LSA. Possible examples include: 1) the LSA is a summary-LSA
  or AS-external-LSA and the router no longer has an (advertisable)



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 130]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  route to the destination, 2) the LSA is a network-LSA but the router
  is no longer Designated Router for the network or 3) the LSA is a
  network-LSA whose Link State ID is one of the router's own IP
  interface addresses but whose Advertising Router is not equal to the
  router's own Router ID (this latter case should be rare, and it
  indicates that the router's Router ID has changed since originating
  the LSA).  In all these cases, instead of updating the LSA, the LSA
  should be flushed from the routing domain by incrementing the
  received LSA's LS age to MaxAge and reflooding (see Section 14.1).

13.5.  Sending Link State Acknowledgment packets

  Each newly received LSA must be acknowledged.  This is usually done
  by sending Link State Acknowledgment packets.  However,
  acknowledgments can also be accomplished implicitly by sending Link
  State Update packets (see step 7a of Section 13).

  Many acknowledgments may be grouped together into a single Link State
  Acknowledgment packet.  Such a packet is sent back out the interface
  which received the LSAs.  The packet can be sent in one of two ways:
  delayed and sent on an interval timer, or sent directly (as a
  unicast) to a particular neighbor.  The particular acknowledgment
  strategy used depends on the circumstances surrounding the receipt of
  the LSA.

  Sending delayed acknowledgments accomplishes several things: 1) it
  facilitates the packaging of multiple acknowledgments in a single
  Link State Acknowledgment packet, 2) it enables a single Link State
  Acknowledgment packet to indicate acknowledgments to several
  neighbors at once (through multicasting) and 3) it randomizes the
  Link State Acknowledgment packets sent by the various routers
  attached to a common network.  The fixed interval between a router's
  delayed transmissions must be short (less than RxmtInterval) or
  needless retransmissions will ensue.

  Direct acknowledgments are sent to a particular neighbor in response
  to the receipt of duplicate LSAs.  These acknowledgments are sent as
  unicasts, and are sent immediately when the duplicate is received.

  The precise procedure for sending Link State Acknowledgment packets
  is described in Table 19.  The circumstances surrounding the receipt
  of the LSA are listed in the left column.  The acknowledgment action
  then taken is listed in one of the two right columns.  This action
  depends on the state of the concerned interface; interfaces in state
  Backup behave differently from interfaces in all other states.
  Delayed acknowledgments must be delivered to all adjacent routers
  associated with the interface.  On broadcast networks, this is
  accomplished by sending the delayed Link State Acknowledgment packets



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 131]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  as multicasts.  The Destination IP address used depends on the state
  of the interface.  If the interface state is DR or Backup, the
  destination AllSPFRouters is used.  In all other states, the
  destination AllDRouters is used.  On non-broadcast networks, delayed
  Link State Acknowledgment packets must be unicast separately over
  each adjacency (i.e., neighbor whose state is >= Exchange).

                                   Action taken in state
   Circumstances          Backup                All other states
   _______________________________________________________________
   LSA  has               No  acknowledgment    No  acknowledgment
   been  flooded back     sent.                 sent.
   out receiving  in-
   terface  (see Sec-
   tion 13, step 5b).
   _______________________________________________________________
   LSA   is               Delayed acknowledg-   Delayed       ack-
   more  recent  than     ment sent if adver-   nowledgment sent.
   database copy, but     tisement   received
   was   not  flooded     from    Designated
   back out receiving     Router,  otherwise
   interface              do nothing
   _______________________________________________________________
   LSA is a               Delayed acknowledg-   No  acknowledgment
   duplicate, and was     ment sent if adver-   sent.
   treated as an  im-     tisement   received
   plied  acknowledg-     from    Designated
   ment (see  Section     Router,  otherwise
   13, step 7a).          do nothing
   _______________________________________________________________
   LSA is a               Direct acknowledg-    Direct acknowledg-
   duplicate, and was     ment sent.            ment sent.
   not treated as  an
   implied       ack-
   nowledgment.
   _______________________________________________________________
   LSA's LS               Direct acknowledg-    Direct acknowledg-
   age is equal to        ment sent.            ment sent.
   MaxAge, and there is
   no current instance
   of the LSA
   in the link state
   database (see
   Section 13, step 4).


            Table 19: Sending link state acknowledgments.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 132]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The reasoning behind sending the above packets as multicasts is best
  explained by an example.  Consider the network configuration depicted
  in Figure 15.  Suppose RT4 has been elected as Designated Router, and
  RT3 as Backup Designated Router for the network N3.  When Router RT4
  floods a new LSA to Network N3, it is received by routers RT1, RT2,
  and RT3.  These routers will not flood the LSA back onto net N3, but
  they still must ensure that their link-state databases remain
  synchronized with their adjacent neighbors.  So RT1, RT2, and RT4 are
  waiting to see an acknowledgment from RT3.  Likewise, RT4 and RT3 are
  both waiting to see acknowledgments from RT1 and RT2.  This is best
  achieved by sending the acknowledgments as multicasts.

  The reason that the acknowledgment logic for Backup DRs is slightly
  different is because they perform differently during the flooding of
  LSAs (see Section 13.3, step 4).


13.6.  Retransmitting LSAs

  LSAs flooded out an adjacency are placed on the adjacency's Link
  state retransmission list.  In order to ensure that flooding is
  reliable, these LSAs are retransmitted until they are acknowledged.
  The length of time between retransmissions is a configurable per-
  interface value, RxmtInterval.  If this is set too low for an
  interface, needless retransmissions will ensue.  If the value is set
  too high, the speed of the flooding, in the face of lost packets, may
  be affected.

  Several retransmitted LSAs may fit into a single Link State Update
  packet.  When LSAs are to be retransmitted, only the number fitting
  in a single Link State Update packet should be sent.  Another packet
  of retransmissions can be sent whenever some of the LSAs are
  acknowledged, or on the next firing of the retransmission timer.

  Link State Update Packets carrying retransmissions are always sent as
  unicasts (directly to the physical address of the neighbor).  They
  are never sent as multicasts.  Each LSA's LS age must be incremented
  by InfTransDelay (which must be > 0) when it is copied into the
  outgoing Link State Update packet (until the LS age field reaches the
  maximum value of MaxAge).

  If an adjacent router goes down, retransmissions may occur until the
  adjacency is destroyed by OSPF's Hello Protocol.  When the adjacency
  is destroyed, the Link state retransmission list is cleared.







Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 133]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


13.7.  Receiving link state acknowledgments

  Many consistency checks have been made on a received Link State
  Acknowledgment packet before it is handed to the flooding procedure.
  In particular, it has been associated with a particular neighbor.  If
  this neighbor is in a lesser state than Exchange, the Link State
  Acknowledgment packet is discarded.

  Otherwise, for each acknowledgment in the Link State Acknowledgment
  packet, the following steps are performed:


  o   Does the LSA acknowledged have an instance on the Link state
      retransmission list for the neighbor?  If not, examine the
      next acknowledgment.  Otherwise:

  o   If the acknowledgment is for the same instance that is
      contained on the list, remove the item from the list and
      examine the next acknowledgment.  Otherwise:

     o   Log the questionable acknowledgment, and examine the next
         one.

14.  Aging The Link State Database

  Each LSA has an LS age field.  The LS age is expressed in seconds.
  An LSA's LS age field is incremented while it is contained in a
  router's database.  Also, when copied into a Link State Update Packet
  for flooding out a particular interface, the LSA's LS age is
  incremented by InfTransDelay.

  An LSA's LS age is never incremented past the value MaxAge.  LSAs
  having age MaxAge are not used in the routing table calculation.  As
  a router ages its link state database, an LSA's LS age may reach
  MaxAge.[21]  At this time, the router must attempt to flush the LSA
  from the routing domain.  This is done simply by reflooding the
  MaxAge LSA just as if it was a newly originated LSA (see Section
  13.3).

  When creating a Database summary list for a newly forming adjacency,
  any MaxAge LSAs present in the link state database are added to the
  neighbor's Link state retransmission list instead of the neighbor's
  Database summary list.  See Section 10.3 for more details.

  A MaxAge LSA must be removed immediately from the router's link state
  database as soon as both a) it is no longer contained on any neighbor
  Link state retransmission lists and b) none of the router's neighbors
  are in states Exchange or Loading.



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 134]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  When, in the process of aging the link state database, an LSA's LS
  age hits a multiple of CheckAge, its LS checksum should be verified.
  If the LS checksum is incorrect, a program or memory error has been
  detected, and at the very least the router itself should be
  restarted.

14.1.  Premature aging of LSAs

  An LSA can be flushed from the routing domain by setting its LS age
  to MaxAge and reflooding the LSA.  This procedure follows the same
  course as flushing an LSA whose LS age has naturally reached the
  value MaxAge (see Section 14).  In particular, the MaxAge LSA is
  removed from the router's link state database as soon as a) it is no
  longer contained on any neighbor Link state retransmission lists and
  b) none of the router's neighbors are in states Exchange or Loading.
  We call the setting of an LSA's LS age to MaxAge "premature aging".

  Premature aging is used when it is time for a self-originated LSA's
  sequence number field to wrap.  At this point, the current LSA
  instance (having LS sequence number MaxSequenceNumber) must be
  prematurely aged and flushed from the routing domain before a new
  instance with sequence number equal to InitialSequenceNumber can be
  originated.  See Section 12.1.6 for more information.

  Premature aging can also be used when, for example, one of the
  router's previously advertised external routes is no longer
  reachable.  In this circumstance, the router can flush its AS-
  external-LSA from the routing domain via premature aging. This
  procedure is preferable to the alternative, which is to originate a
  new LSA for the destination specifying a metric of LSInfinity.
  Premature aging is also be used when unexpectedly receiving self-
  originated LSAs during the flooding procedure (see Section 13.4).

  A router may only prematurely age its own self-originated LSAs.  The
  router may not prematurely age LSAs that have been originated by
  other routers. An LSA is considered self- originated when either 1)
  the LSA's Advertising Router is equal to the router's own Router ID
  or 2) the LSA is a network-LSA and its Link State ID is equal to one
  of the router's own IP interface addresses.

15.  Virtual Links

  The single backbone area (Area ID = 0.0.0.0) cannot be disconnected,
  or some areas of the Autonomous System will become unreachable.  To
  establish/maintain connectivity of the backbone, virtual links can be
  configured through non-backbone areas.  Virtual links serve to
  connect physically separate components of the backbone.  The two
  endpoints of a virtual link are area border routers.  The virtual



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 135]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  link must be configured in both routers.  The configuration
  information in each router consists of the other virtual endpoint
  (the other area border router), and the non-backbone area the two
  routers have in common (called the Transit area).  Virtual links
  cannot be configured through stub areas (see Section 3.6).

  The virtual link is treated as if it were an unnumbered point-to-
  point network belonging to the backbone and joining the two area
  border routers.  An attempt is made to establish an adjacency over
  the virtual link.  When this adjacency is established, the virtual
  link will be included in backbone router-LSAs, and OSPF packets
  pertaining to the backbone area will flow over the adjacency.  Such
  an adjacency has been referred to in this document as a "virtual
  adjacency".

  In each endpoint router, the cost and viability of the virtual link
  is discovered by examining the routing table entry for the other
  endpoint router.  (The entry's associated area must be the configured
  Transit area).  This is called the virtual link's corresponding
  routing table entry. The InterfaceUp event occurs for a virtual link
  when its corresponding routing table entry becomes reachable.
  Conversely, the InterfaceDown event occurs when its routing table
  entry becomes unreachable.  In other words, the virtual link's
  viability is determined by the existence of an intra-area path,
  through the Transit area, between the two endpoints. Note that a
  virtual link whose underlying path has cost greater than hexadecimal
  0xffff (the maximum size of an interface cost in a router-LSA) should
  be considered inoperational (i.e., treated the same as if the path
  did not exist).

  The other details concerning virtual links are as follows:

  o AS-external-LSAs are NEVER flooded over virtual adjacencies.  This
  would be duplication of effort, since the same AS-external-LSAs are
  already flooded throughout the virtual link's Transit area.  For this
  same reason, AS-external-LSAs are not summarized over virtual
  adjacencies during the Database Exchange process.

  o The cost of a virtual link is NOT configured.  It is defined to be
  the cost of the intra-area path between the two defining area border
  routers.  This cost appears in the virtual link's corresponding
  routing table entry.  When the cost of a virtual link changes, a new
  router-LSA should be originated for the backbone area.

  o Just as the virtual link's cost and viability are determined by the
  routing table build process (through construction of the routing
  table entry for the other endpoint), so are the IP interface address
  for the virtual interface and the virtual neighbor's IP address.



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 136]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  These are used when sending OSPF protocol packets over the virtual
  link. Note that when one (or both) of the virtual link endpoints
  connect to the Transit area via an unnumbered point-to-point link, it
  may be impossible to calculate either the virtual interface's IP
  address and/or the virtual neighbor's IP address, thereby causing the
  virtual link to fail.

  o In each endpoint's router-LSA for the backbone, the virtual link is
  represented as a Type 4 link whose Link ID is set to the virtual
  neighbor's OSPF Router ID and whose Link Data is set to the virtual
  interface's IP address.  See Section 12.4.1 for more information.

  o A non-backbone area can carry transit data traffic (i.e., is
  considered a "transit area") if and only if it serves as the Transit
  area for one or more fully adjacent virtual links (see
  TransitCapability in Sections 6 and 16.1). Such an area requires
  special treatment when summarizing backbone networks into it (see
  Section 12.4.3), and during the routing calculation (see Section
  16.3).

  o The time between link state retransmissions, RxmtInterval, is
  configured for a virtual link. This should be well over the expected
  round-trip delay between the two routers.  This may be hard to
  estimate for a virtual link; it is better to err on the side of
  making it too large.

16.  Calculation of the routing table

  This section details the OSPF routing table calculation.  Using its
  attached areas' link state databases as input, a router runs the
  following algorithm, building its routing table step by step.  At
  each step, the router must access individual pieces of the link state
  databases (e.g., a router-LSA originated by a certain router).  This
  access is performed by the lookup function discussed in Section 12.2.
  The lookup process may return an LSA whose LS age is equal to MaxAge.
  Such an LSA should not be used in the routing table calculation, and
  is treated just as if the lookup process had failed.

  The OSPF routing table's organization is explained in Section 11.
  Two examples of the routing table build process are presented in
  Sections 11.2 and 11.3.  This process can be broken into the
  following steps:

  (1) The present routing table is invalidated.  The routing table is
       built again from scratch.  The old routing table is saved so
       that changes in routing table entries can be identified.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 137]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (2) The intra-area routes are calculated by building the shortest-
      path tree for each attached area.  In particular, all routing
      table entries whose Destination Type is "area border router" are
      calculated in this step.  This step is described in two parts.
      At first the tree is constructed by only considering those links
      between routers and transit networks.  Then the stub networks
      are incorporated into the tree.  During the area's shortest-path
      tree calculation, the area's TransitCapability is also
      calculated for later use in Step 4.

  (3) The inter-area routes are calculated, through examination of
      summary-LSAs.  If the router is attached to multiple areas
      (i.e., it is an area border router), only backbone summary-LSAs
      are examined.

  (4) In area border routers connecting to one or more transit areas
      (i.e, non-backbone areas whose TransitCapability is found to be
      TRUE), the transit areas' summary-LSAs are examined to see
      whether better paths exist using the transit areas than were
      found in Steps 2-3 above.

  (5) Routes to external destinations are calculated, through
      examination of AS-external-LSAs.  The locations of the AS
      boundary routers (which originate the AS-external-LSAs) have
      been determined in steps 2-4.

  Steps 2-5 are explained in further detail below.

  Changes made to routing table entries as a result of these
  calculations can cause the OSPF protocol to take further actions.
  For example, a change to an intra-area route will cause an area
  border router to originate new summary-LSAs (see Section 12.4).  See

  Section 16.7 for a complete list of the OSPF protocol actions
  resulting from routing table changes.

16.1.  Calculating the shortest-path tree for an area

  This calculation yields the set of intra-area routes associated with
  an area (called hereafter Area A).  A router calculates the
  shortest-path tree using itself as the root.[22] The formation of the
  shortest path tree is done here in two stages.  In the first stage,
  only links between routers and transit networks are considered.
  Using the Dijkstra algorithm, a tree is formed from this subset of
  the link state database.  In the second stage, leaves are added to
  the tree by considering the links to stub networks.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 138]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The procedure will be explained using the graph terminology that was
  introduced in Section 2.  The area's link state database is
  represented as a directed graph.  The graph's vertices are routers,
  transit networks and stub networks.  The first stage of the procedure
  concerns only the transit vertices (routers and transit networks) and
  their connecting links.  Throughout the shortest path calculation,
  the following data is also associated with each transit vertex:


  Vertex (node) ID
      A 32-bit number uniquely identifying the vertex.  For router
      vertices this is the router's OSPF Router ID.  For network
      vertices, this is the IP address of the network's Designated
      Router.

  An LSA
      Each transit vertex has an associated LSA.  For router
      vertices, this is a router-LSA.  For transit networks, this
      is a network-LSA (which is actually originated by the
      network's Designated Router).  In any case, the LSA's Link
      State ID is always equal to the above Vertex ID.

  List of next hops
      The list of next hops for the current set of shortest paths
      from the root to this vertex.  There can be multiple
      shortest paths due to the equal-cost multipath capability.
      Each next hop indicates the outgoing router interface to use
      when forwarding traffic to the destination.  On broadcast,
      Point-to-MultiPoint and NBMA networks, the next hop also
      includes the IP address of the next router (if any) in the
      path towards the destination.

  Distance from root
      The link state cost of the current set of shortest paths
      from the root to the vertex.  The link state cost of a path
      is calculated as the sum of the costs of the path's
      constituent links (as advertised in router-LSAs and
      network-LSAs).  One path is said to be "shorter" than
      another if it has a smaller link state cost.


  The first stage of the procedure (i.e., the Dijkstra algorithm) can
  now be summarized as follows. At each iteration of the algorithm,
  there is a list of candidate vertices.  Paths from the root to these
  vertices have been found, but not necessarily the shortest ones.
  However, the paths to the candidate vertex that is closest to the
  root are guaranteed to be shortest; this vertex is added to the
  shortest-path tree, removed from the candidate list, and its adjacent



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 139]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  vertices are examined for possible addition to/modification of the
  candidate list.  The algorithm then iterates again.  It terminates
  when the candidate list becomes empty.

  The following steps describe the algorithm in detail.  Remember that
  we are computing the shortest path tree for Area A.  All references
  to link state database lookup below are from Area A's database.

  (1) Initialize the algorithm's data structures.  Clear the list
      of candidate vertices.  Initialize the shortest-path tree to
      only the root (which is the router doing the calculation).
      Set Area A's TransitCapability to FALSE.

  (2) Call the vertex just added to the tree vertex V.  Examine
      the LSA associated with vertex V.  This is a lookup in the
      Area A's link state database based on the Vertex ID.  If
      this is a router-LSA, and bit V of the router-LSA (see
      Section A.4.2) is set, set Area A's TransitCapability to
      TRUE.  In any case, each link described by the LSA gives the
      cost to an adjacent vertex.  For each described link, (say
      it joins vertex V to vertex W):

      (a) If this is a link to a stub network, examine the next
          link in V's LSA.  Links to stub networks will be
          considered in the second stage of the shortest path
          calculation.

      (b) Otherwise, W is a transit vertex (router or transit
          network).  Look up the vertex W's LSA (router-LSA or
          network-LSA) in Area A's link state database.  If the
          LSA does not exist, or its LS age is equal to MaxAge, or
          it does not have a link back to vertex V, examine the
          next link in V's LSA.[23]

      (c) If vertex W is already on the shortest-path tree,
          examine the next link in the LSA.

      (d) Calculate the link state cost D of the resulting path
          from the root to vertex W.  D is equal to the sum of the
          link state cost of the (already calculated) shortest
          path to vertex V and the advertised cost of the link
          between vertices V and W.  If D is:

          o   Greater than the value that already appears for
              vertex W on the candidate list, then examine the
              next link.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 140]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


          o   Equal to the value that appears for vertex W on the
              candidate list, calculate the set of next hops that
              result from using the advertised link.  Input to
              this calculation is the destination (W), and its
              parent (V).  This calculation is shown in Section
              16.1.1.  This set of hops should be added to the
              next hop values that appear for W on the candidate
              list.

          o   Less than the value that appears for vertex W on the
              candidate list, or if W does not yet appear on the
              candidate list, then set the entry for W on the
              candidate list to indicate a distance of D from the
              root.  Also calculate the list of next hops that
              result from using the advertised link, setting the
              next hop values for W accordingly.  The next hop
              calculation is described in Section 16.1.1; it takes
              as input the destination (W) and its parent (V).

  (3) If at this step the candidate list is empty, the shortest-
      path tree (of transit vertices) has been completely built
      and this stage of the procedure terminates.  Otherwise,
      choose the vertex belonging to the candidate list that is
      closest to the root, and add it to the shortest-path tree
      (removing it from the candidate list in the process). Note
      that when there is a choice of vertices closest to the root,
      network vertices must be chosen before router vertices in
      order to necessarily find all equal-cost paths. This is
      consistent with the tie-breakers that were introduced in the
      modified Dijkstra algorithm used by OSPF's Multicast routing
      extensions (MOSPF).

  (4) Possibly modify the routing table.  For those routing table
      entries modified, the associated area will be set to Area A,
      the path type will be set to intra-area, and the cost will
      be set to the newly discovered shortest path's calculated
      distance.

      If the newly added vertex is an area border router or AS
      boundary router, a routing table entry is added whose
      destination type is "router".  The Options field found in
      the associated router-LSA is copied into the routing table
      entry's Optional capabilities field. Call the newly added
      vertex Router X.  If Router X is the endpoint of one of the
      calculating router's virtual links, and the virtual link
      uses Area A as Transit area:  the virtual link is declared
      up, the IP address of the virtual interface is set to the IP
      address of the outgoing interface calculated above for



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 141]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      Router X, and the virtual neighbor's IP address is set to
      Router X's interface address (contained in Router X's
      router-LSA) that points back to the root of the shortest-
      path tree; equivalently, this is the interface that points
      back to Router X's parent vertex on the shortest-path tree
      (similar to the calculation in Section 16.1.1).

      If the newly added vertex is a transit network, the routing
      table entry for the network is located.  The entry's
      Destination ID is the IP network number, which can be
      obtained by masking the Vertex ID (Link State ID) with its
      associated subnet mask (found in the body of the associated
      network-LSA).  If the routing table entry already exists
      (i.e., there is already an intra-area route to the
      destination installed in the routing table), multiple
      vertices have mapped to the same IP network.  For example,
      this can occur when a new Designated Router is being
      established.  In this case, the current routing table entry
      should be overwritten if and only if the newly found path is
      just as short and the current routing table entry's Link
      State Origin has a smaller Link State ID than the newly
      added vertex' LSA.

      If there is no routing table entry for the network (the
      usual case), a routing table entry for the IP network should
      be added.  The routing table entry's Link State Origin
      should be set to the newly added vertex' LSA.

  (5) Iterate the algorithm by returning to Step 2.

  The stub networks are added to the tree in the procedure's second
  stage.  In this stage, all router vertices are again examined.  Those
  that have been determined to be unreachable in the above first phase
  are discarded.  For each reachable router vertex (call it V), the
  associated router-LSA is found in the link state database.  Each stub
  network link appearing in the LSA is then examined, and the following
  steps are executed:


  (1) Calculate the distance D of stub network from the root.  D
      is equal to the distance from the root to the router vertex
      (calculated in stage 1), plus the stub network link's
      advertised cost.  Compare this distance to the current best
      cost to the stub network.  This is done by looking up the
      stub network's current routing table entry.  If the
      calculated distance D is larger, go on to examine the next
      stub network link in the LSA.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 142]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (2) If this step is reached, the stub network's routing table
      entry must be updated.  Calculate the set of next hops that
      would result from using the stub network link.  This
      calculation is shown in Section 16.1.1; input to this
      calculation is the destination (the stub network) and the
      parent vertex (the router vertex).  If the distance D is the
      same as the current routing table cost, simply add this set
      of next hops to the routing table entry's list of next hops.
      In this case, the routing table already has a Link State
      Origin.  If this Link State Origin is a router-LSA whose
      Link State ID is smaller than V's Router ID, reset the Link
      State Origin to V's router-LSA.

      Otherwise D is smaller than the routing table cost.
      Overwrite the current routing table entry by setting the
      routing table entry's cost to D, and by setting the entry's
      list of next hops to the newly calculated set.  Set the
      routing table entry's Link State Origin to V's router-LSA.
      Then go on to examine the next stub network link.

  For all routing table entries added/modified in the second stage, the
  associated area will be set to Area A and the path type will be set to
  intra-area.  When the list of reachable router-LSAs is exhausted, the
  second stage is completed.  At this time, all intra-area routes
  associated with Area A have been determined.

  The specification does not require that the above two stage method be
  used to calculate the shortest path tree.  However, if another
  algorithm is used, an identical tree must be produced.  For this
  reason, it is important to note that links between transit vertices
  must be bidirectional in order to be included in the above tree.  It
  should also be mentioned that more efficient algorithms exist for
  calculating the tree; for example, the incremental SPF algorithm
  described in [Ref1].

















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 143]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


16.1.1.  The next hop calculation

  This section explains how to calculate the current set of next hops
  to use for a destination.  Each next hop consists of the outgoing
  interface to use in forwarding packets to the destination together
  with the IP address of the next hop router (if any).  The next hop
  calculation is invoked each time a shorter path to the destination is
  discovered.  This can happen in either stage of the shortest-path
  tree calculation (see Section 16.1).  In stage 1 of the shortest-path
  tree calculation a shorter path is found as the destination is added
  to the candidate list, or when the destination's entry on the
  candidate list is modified (Step 2d of Stage 1).  In stage 2 a
  shorter path is discovered each time the destination's routing table
  entry is modified (Step 2 of Stage 2).

  The set of next hops to use for the destination may be recalculated
  several times during the shortest-path tree calculation, as shorter
  and shorter paths are discovered.  In the end, the destination's
  routing table entry will always reflect the next hops resulting from
  the absolute shortest path(s).

  Input to the next hop calculation is a) the destination and b) its
  parent in the current shortest path between the root (the calculating
  router) and the destination.  The parent is always a transit vertex
  (i.e., always a router or a transit network).

  If there is at least one intervening router in the current shortest
  path between the destination and the root, the destination simply
  inherits the set of next hops from the parent.  Otherwise, there are
  two cases.  In the first case, the parent vertex is the root (the
  calculating router itself).  This means that the destination is
  either a directly connected network or directly connected router.
  The outgoing interface in this case is simply the OSPF interface
  connecting to the destination network/router. If the destination is a
  router which connects to the calculating router via a Point-to-
  MultiPoint network, the destination's next hop IP address(es) can be
  determined by examining the destination's router-LSA: each link
  pointing back to the calculating router and having a Link Data field
  belonging to the Point-to-MultiPoint network provides an IP address
  of the next hop router. If the destination is a directly connected
  network, or a router which connects to the calculating router via a
  point-to-point interface, no next hop IP address is required. If the
  destination is a router connected to the calculating router via a
  virtual link, the setting of the next hop should be deferred until
  the calculation in Section 16.3.






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 144]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  In the second case, the parent vertex is a network that directly
  connects the calculating router to the destination router.  The list
  of next hops is then determined by examining the destination's
  router-LSA.  For each link in the router-LSA that points back to the
  parent network, the link's Link Data field provides the IP address of
  a next hop router.  The outgoing interface to use can then be derived
  from the next hop IP address (or it can be inherited from the parent
  network).

16.2.  Calculating the inter-area routes

  The inter-area routes are calculated by examining summary-LSAs.  If
  the router has active attachments to multiple areas, only backbone
  summary-LSAs are examined.  Routers attached to a single area examine
  that area's summary-LSAs.  In either case, the summary-LSAs examined
  below are all part of a single area's link state database (call it
  Area A).

  Summary-LSAs are originated by the area border routers.  Each
  summary-LSA in Area A is considered in turn.  Remember that the
  destination described by a summary-LSA is either a network (Type 3
  summary-LSAs) or an AS boundary router (Type 4 summary-LSAs).  For
  each summary-LSA:


  (1) If the cost specified by the LSA is LSInfinity, or if the
      LSA's LS age is equal to MaxAge, then examine the the next
      LSA.

  (2) If the LSA was originated by the calculating router itself,
      examine the next LSA.

  (3) If it is a Type 3 summary-LSA, and the collection of
      destinations described by the summary-LSA equals one of the
      router's configured area address ranges (see Section 3.5),
      and the particular area address range is active, then the
      summary-LSA should be ignored.  "Active" means that there
      are one or more reachable (by intra-area paths) networks
      contained in the area range.

  (4) Else, call the destination described by the LSA N (for Type
      3 summary-LSAs, N's address is obtained by masking the LSA's
      Link State ID with the network/subnet mask contained in the
      body of the LSA), and the area border originating the LSA
      BR.  Look up the routing table entry for BR having Area A as
      its associated area.  If no such entry exists for router BR
      (i.e., BR is unreachable in Area A), do nothing with this
      LSA and consider the next in the list.  Else, this LSA



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 145]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      describes an inter-area path to destination N, whose cost is
      the distance to BR plus the cost specified in the LSA. Call
      the cost of this inter-area path IAC.

  (5) Next, look up the routing table entry for the destination N.
      (If N is an AS boundary router, look up the "router" routing
      table entry associated with Area A).  If no entry exists for
      N or if the entry's path type is "type 1 external" or "type
      2 external", then install the inter-area path to N, with
      associated area Area A, cost IAC, next hop equal to the list
      of next hops to router BR, and Advertising router equal to
      BR.

  (6) Else, if the paths present in the table are intra-area
      paths, do nothing with the LSA (intra-area paths are always
      preferred).

  (7) Else, the paths present in the routing table are also
      inter-area paths.  Install the new path through BR if it is
      cheaper, overriding the paths in the routing table.
      Otherwise, if the new path is the same cost, add it to the
      list of paths that appear in the routing table entry.

16.3.  Examining transit areas' summary-LSAs

  This step is only performed by area border routers attached to one or
  more non-backbone areas that are capable of carrying transit traffic
  (i.e., "transit areas", or those areas whose TransitCapability
  parameter has been set to TRUE in Step 2 of the Dijkstra algorithm
  (see Section 16.1).

  The purpose of the calculation below is to examine the transit areas
  to see whether they provide any better (shorter) paths than the paths
  previously calculated in Sections 16.1 and 16.2.  Any paths found
  that are better than or equal to previously discovered paths are
  installed in the routing table.

  The calculation proceeds as follows. All the transit areas' summary-
  LSAs are examined in turn.  Each such summary-LSA describes a route
  through a transit area Area A to a Network N (N's address is obtained
  by masking the LSA's Link State ID with the network/subnet mask
  contained in the body of the LSA) or in the case of a Type 4
  summary-LSA, to an AS boundary router N.  Suppose also that the
  summary-LSA was originated by an area border router BR.

  (1) If the cost advertised by the summary-LSA is LSInfinity, or
      if the LSA's LS age is equal to MaxAge, then examine the
      next LSA.



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 146]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (2) If the summary-LSA was originated by the calculating router
      itself, examine the next LSA.

  (3) Look up the routing table entry for N. (If N is an AS
      boundary router, look up the "router" routing table entry
      associated with the backbone area). If it does not exist, or
      if the route type is other than intra-area or inter-area, or
      if the area associated with the routing table entry is not
      the backbone area, then examine the next LSA. In other
      words, this calculation only updates backbone intra-area
      routes found in Section 16.1 and inter-area routes found in
      Section 16.2.

  (4) Look up the routing table entry for the advertising router
      BR associated with the Area A. If it is unreachable, examine
      the next LSA. Otherwise, the cost to destination N is the
      sum of the cost in BR's Area A routing table entry and the
      cost advertised in the LSA. Call this cost IAC.

  (5) If this cost is less than the cost occurring in N's routing
      table entry, overwrite N's list of next hops with those used
      for BR, and set N's routing table cost to IAC. Else, if IAC
      is the same as N's current cost, add BR's list of next hops
      to N's list of next hops. In any case, the area associated
      with N's routing table entry must remain the backbone area,
      and the path type (either intra-area or inter-area) must
      also remain the same.
























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 147]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


                     . Area 1 (transit)     .            +
                     .                      .            |
                     .      +---+1        1+---+100      |
                     .      |RT2|----------|RT4|=========|
                     .    1/+---+********* +---+         |
                     .    /*******          .            |
                     .  1/*Virtual          .            |
                  1+---+/*  Link            .         Net|work
            =======|RT1|*                   .            | N1
                   +---+\                   .            |
                     .   \                  .            |
                     .    \                 .            |
                     .    1\+---+1        1+---+20       |
                     .      |RT3|----------|RT5|=========|
                     .      +---+          +---+         |
                     .                      .            |
                     ........................            +


               Figure 17: Routing through transit areas

  It is important to note that the above calculation never makes
  unreachable destinations reachable, but instead just potentially
  finds better paths to already reachable destinations.  The
  calculation installs any better cost found into the routing table
  entry, from which it may be readvertised in summary-LSAs to other
  areas.

  As an example of the calculation, consider the Autonomous System
  pictured in Figure 17. There is a single non-backbone area (Area 1)
  that physically divides the backbone into two separate pieces. To
  maintain connectivity of the backbone, a virtual link has been
  configured between routers RT1 and RT4. On the right side of the
  figure, Network N1 belongs to the backbone. The dotted lines indicate
  that there is a much shorter intra-area backbone path between router
  RT5 and Network N1 (cost 20) than there is between Router RT4 and
  Network N1 (cost 100). Both Router RT4 and Router RT5 will inject
  summary-LSAs for Network N1 into Area 1.

  After the shortest-path tree has been calculated for the backbone in
  Section 16.1, Router RT1 (left end of the virtual link) will have
  calculated a path through Router RT4 for all data traffic destined
  for Network N1. However, since Router RT5 is so much closer to
  Network N1, all routers internal to Area 1 (e.g., Routers RT2 and
  RT3) will forward their Network N1 traffic towards Router RT5,
  instead of RT4. And indeed, after examining Area 1's summary-LSAs by
  the above calculation, Router RT1 will also forward Network N1
  traffic towards RT5. Note that in this example the virtual link



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 148]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  enables transit data traffic to be forwarded through Area 1, but the
  actual path the transit data traffic takes does not follow the
  virtual link.  In other words, virtual links allow transit traffic to
  be forwarded through an area, but do not dictate the precise path
  that the traffic will take.

16.4.  Calculating AS external routes

  AS external routes are calculated by examining AS-external-LSAs.
  Each of the AS-external-LSAs is considered in turn.  Most AS-
  external-LSAs describe routes to specific IP destinations.  An AS-
  external-LSA can also describe a default route for the Autonomous
  System (Destination ID = DefaultDestination, network/subnet mask =
  0x00000000).  For each AS-external-LSA:

  (1) If the cost specified by the LSA is LSInfinity, or if the
      LSA's LS age is equal to MaxAge, then examine the next LSA.

  (2) If the LSA was originated by the calculating router itself,
      examine the next LSA.

  (3) Call the destination described by the LSA N.  N's address is
      obtained by masking the LSA's Link State ID with the
      network/subnet mask contained in the body of the LSA.  Look
      up the routing table entries (potentially one per attached
      area) for the AS boundary router (ASBR) that originated the
      LSA. If no entries exist for router ASBR (i.e., ASBR is
      unreachable), do nothing with this LSA and consider the next
      in the list.

      Else, this LSA describes an AS external path to destination
      N.  Examine the forwarding address specified in the AS-
      external-LSA.  This indicates the IP address to which
      packets for the destination should be forwarded.

      If the forwarding address is set to 0.0.0.0, packets should
      be sent to the ASBR itself. Among the multiple routing table
      entries for the ASBR, select the preferred entry as follows.
      If RFC1583Compatibility is set to "disabled", prune the set
      of routing table entries for the ASBR as described in
      Section 16.4.1. In any case, among the remaining routing
      table entries, select the routing table entry with the least
      cost; when there are multiple least cost routing table
      entries the entry whose associated area has the largest OSPF
      Area ID (when considered as an unsigned 32-bit integer) is
      chosen.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 149]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      If the forwarding address is non-zero, look up the
      forwarding address in the routing table.[24] The matching
      routing table entry must specify an intra-area or inter-area
      path; if no such path exists, do nothing with the LSA and
      consider the next in the list.

  (4) Let X be the cost specified by the preferred routing table
      entry for the ASBR/forwarding address, and Y the cost
      specified in the LSA.  X is in terms of the link state
      metric, and Y is a type 1 or 2 external metric.

  (5) Look up the routing table entry for the destination N.  If
      no entry exists for N, install the AS external path to N,
      with next hop equal to the list of next hops to the
      forwarding address, and advertising router equal to ASBR.
      If the external metric type is 1, then the path-type is set
      to type 1 external and the cost is equal to X+Y.  If the
      external metric type is 2, the path-type is set to type 2
      external, the link state component of the route's cost is X,
      and the type 2 cost is Y.

  (6) Compare the AS external path described by the LSA with the
      existing paths in N's routing table entry, as follows. If
      the new path is preferred, it replaces the present paths in
      N's routing table entry.  If the new path is of equal
      preference, it is added to N's routing table entry's list of
      paths.

      (a) Intra-area and inter-area paths are always preferred
          over AS external paths.

      (b) Type 1 external paths are always preferred over type 2
          external paths. When all paths are type 2 external
          paths, the paths with the smallest advertised type 2
          metric are always preferred.

      (c) If the new AS external path is still indistinguishable
          from the current paths in the N's routing table entry,
          and RFC1583Compatibility is set to "disabled", select
          the preferred paths based on the intra-AS paths to the
          ASBR/forwarding addresses, as specified in Section
          16.4.1.









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 150]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      (d) If the new AS external path is still indistinguishable
          from the current paths in the N's routing table entry,
          select the preferred path based on a least cost
          comparison.  Type 1 external paths are compared by
          looking at the sum of the distance to the forwarding
          address and the advertised type 1 metric (X+Y).  Type 2
          external paths advertising equal type 2 metrics are
          compared by looking at the distance to the forwarding
          addresses.

16.4.1.  External path preferences

  When multiple intra-AS paths are available to ASBRs/forwarding
  addresses, the following rules indicate which paths are preferred.
  These rules apply when the same ASBR is reachable through multiple
  areas, or when trying to decide which of several AS-external-LSAs
  should be preferred. In the former case the paths all terminate at
  the same ASBR, while in the latter the paths terminate at separate
  ASBRs/forwarding addresses. In either case, each path is represented
  by a separate routing table entry as defined in Section 11.

  This section only applies when RFC1583Compatibility is set to
  "disabled".

  The path preference rules, stated from highest to lowest preference,
  are as follows. Note that as a result of these rules, there may still
  be multiple paths of the highest preference. In this case, the path
  to use must be determined based on cost, as described in Section
  16.4.

   o   Intra-area paths using non-backbone areas are always the
       most preferred.

   o   Otherwise, intra-area backbone paths are preferred.

   o   Inter-area paths are the least preferred.

16.5.  Incremental updates -- summary-LSAs

  When a new summary-LSA is received, it is not necessary to
  recalculate the entire routing table.  Call the destination described
  by the summary-LSA N (N's address is obtained by masking the LSA's
  Link State ID with the network/subnet mask contained in the body of
  the LSA), and let Area A be the area to which the LSA belongs. There
  are then two separate cases:






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 151]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Case 1: Area A is the backbone and/or the router is not an area
  border router.
     In this case, the following calculations must be performed.
     First, if there is presently an inter-area route to the
     destination N, N's routing table entry is invalidated, saving the
     entry's values for later comparisons. Then the calculation in
     Section 16.2 is run again for the single destination N. In this
     calculation, all of Area A's summary-LSAs that describe a route to
     N are examined.  In addition, if the router is an area border
     router attached to one or more transit areas, the calculation in
     Section 16.3 must be run again for the single destination.  If the
     results of these calculations have changed the cost/path to an AS
     boundary router (as would be the case for a Type 4 summary-LSA) or
     to any forwarding addresses, all AS- external-LSAs will have to be
     reexamined by rerunning the calculation in Section 16.4.
     Otherwise, if N is now newly unreachable, the calculation in
     Section 16.4 must be rerun for the single destination N, in case
     an alternate external route to N exists.

  Case 2: Area A is a transit area and the router is an area border
  router.
     In this case, the following calculations must be performed.
     First, if N's routing table entry presently contains one or more
     inter-area paths that utilize the transit area Area A, these paths
     should be removed. If this removes all paths from the routing
     table entry, the entry should be invalidated.  The entry's old
     values should be saved for later comparisons. Next the calculation
     in Section 16.3 must be run again for the single destination N. If
     the results of this calculation have caused the cost to N to
     increase, the complete routing table calculation must be rerun
     starting with the Dijkstra algorithm specified in Section 16.1.
     Otherwise, if the cost/path to an AS boundary router (as would be
     the case for a Type 4 summary-LSA) or to any forwarding addresses
     has changed, all AS-external-LSAs will have to be reexamined by
     rerunning the calculation in Section 16.4.  Otherwise, if N is now
     newly unreachable, the calculation in Section 16.4 must be rerun
     for the single destination N, in case an alternate external route
     to N exists.

16.6.  Incremental updates -- AS-external-LSAs

  When a new AS-external-LSA is received, it is not necessary to
  recalculate the entire routing table.  Call the destination described
  by the AS-external-LSA N.  N's address is obtained by masking the
  LSA's Link State ID with the network/subnet mask contained in the
  body of the LSA. If there is already an intra- area or inter-area
  route to the destination, no recalculation is necessary (internal
  routes take precedence).



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 152]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Otherwise, the procedure in Section 16.4 will have to be performed,
  but only for those AS-external-LSAs whose destination is N.  Before
  this procedure is performed, the present routing table entry for N
  should be invalidated.

16.7.  Events generated as a result of routing table changes

  Changes to routing table entries sometimes cause the OSPF area border
  routers to take additional actions.  These routers need to act on the
  following routing table changes:

  o   The cost or path type of a routing table entry has changed.
     If the destination described by this entry is a Network or AS
     boundary router, and this is not simply a change of AS external
     routes, new summary-LSAs may have to be generated (potentially one
     for each attached area, including the backbone). See Section
     12.4.3 for more information.  If a previously advertised entry has
     been deleted, or is no longer advertisable to a particular area,
     the LSA must be flushed from the routing domain by setting its LS
     age to MaxAge and reflooding (see Section 14.1).

  o   A routing table entry associated with a configured virtual
     link has changed.  The destination of such a routing table entry
     is an area border router.  The change indicates a modification to
     the virtual link's cost or viability.

     If the entry indicates that the area border router is newly
     reachable, the corresponding virtual link is now operational.  An
     InterfaceUp event should be generated for the virtual link, which
     will cause a virtual adjacency to begin to form (see Section
     10.3).  At this time the virtual link's IP interface address and
     the virtual neighbor's Neighbor IP address are also calculated.

     If the entry indicates that the area border router is no longer
     reachable, the virtual link and its associated adjacency should be
     destroyed.  This means an InterfaceDown event should be generated
     for the associated virtual link.

     If the cost of the entry has changed, and there is a fully
     established virtual adjacency, a new router-LSA for the backbone
     must be originated.  This in turn may cause further routing table
     changes.









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 153]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


16.8.  Equal-cost multipath

  The OSPF protocol maintains multiple equal-cost routes to all
  destinations.  This can be seen in the steps used above to calculate
  the routing table, and in the definition of the routing table
  structure.

  Each one of the multiple routes will be of the same type (intra-area,
  inter-area, type 1 external or type 2 external), cost, and will have
  the same associated area.  However, each route specifies a separate
  next hop and Advertising router.

  There is no requirement that a router running OSPF keep track of all
  possible equal-cost routes to a destination.  An implementation may
  choose to keep only a fixed number of routes to any given
  destination.  This does not affect any of the algorithms presented in
  this specification.


































Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 154]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


Footnotes

  [1]The graph's vertices represent either routers, transit networks,
  or stub networks.  Since routers may belong to multiple areas, it is
  not possible to color the graph's vertices.

  [2]It is possible for all of a router's interfaces to be unnumbered
  point-to-point links.  In this case, an IP address must be assigned
  to the router.  This address will then be advertised in the router's
  router-LSA as a host route.

  [3]Note that in these cases both interfaces, the non-virtual and the
  virtual, would have the same IP address.

  [4]Note that no host route is generated for, and no IP packets can be
  addressed to, interfaces to unnumbered point-to-point networks.  This
  is regardless of such an interface's state.

  [5]It is instructive to see what happens when the Designated Router
  for the network crashes.  Call the Designated Router for the network
  RT1, and the Backup Designated Router RT2. If Router RT1 crashes (or
  maybe its interface to the network dies), the other routers on the
  network will detect RT1's absence within RouterDeadInterval seconds.
  All routers may not detect this at precisely the same time; the
  routers that detect RT1's absence before RT2 does will, for a time,
  select RT2 to be both Designated Router and Backup Designated Router.
  When RT2 detects that RT1 is gone it will move itself to Designated
  Router.  At this time, the remaining router having highest Router
  Priority will be selected as Backup Designated Router.

  [6]On point-to-point networks, the lower level protocols indicate
  whether the neighbor is up and running.  Likewise, existence of the
  neighbor on virtual links is indicated by the routing table
  calculation.  However, in both these cases, the Hello Protocol is
  still used.  This ensures that communication between the neighbors is
  bidirectional, and that each of the neighbors has a functioning
  routing protocol layer.

  [7]When the identity of the Designated Router is changing, it may be
  quite common for a neighbor in this state to send the router a
  Database Description packet; this means that there is some momentary
  disagreement on the Designated Router's identity.

  [8]Note that it is possible for a router to resynchronize any of its
  fully established adjacencies by setting the adjacency's state back
  to ExStart.  This will cause the other end of the adjacency to
  process a SeqNumberMismatch event, and therefore to also go back to
  ExStart state.



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 155]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  [9]The address space of IP networks and the address space of OSPF
  Router IDs may overlap.  That is, a network may have an IP address
  which is identical (when considered as a 32-bit number) to some
  router's Router ID.

  [10]"Discard" entries are necessary to ensure that route
  summarization at area boundaries will not cause packet looping.

  [11]It is assumed that, for two different address ranges matching the
  destination, one range is more specific than the other. Non-
  contiguous subnet masks can be configured to violate this assumption.
  Such subnet mask configurations cannot be handled by the OSPF
  protocol.

  [12]MaxAgeDiff is an architectural constant.  It indicates the
  maximum dispersion of ages, in seconds, that can occur for a single
  LSA instance as it is flooded throughout the routing domain.  If two
  LSAs differ by more than this, they are assumed to be different
  instances of the same LSA. This can occur when a router restarts and
  loses track of the LSA's previous LS sequence number.  See Section
  13.4 for more details.

  [13]When two LSAs have different LS checksums, they are assumed to be
  separate instances.  This can occur when a router restarts, and loses
  track of the LSA's previous LS sequence number.  In the case where
  the two LSAs have the same LS sequence number, it is not possible to
  determine which LSA is actually newer. However, if the wrong LSA is
  accepted as newer, the originating router will simply originate
  another instance.  See Section 13.4 for further details.

  [14]There is one instance where a lookup must be done based on
  partial information.  This is during the routing table calculation,
  when a network-LSA must be found based solely on its Link State ID.
  The lookup in this case is still well defined, since no two network-
  LSAs can have the same Link State ID.

  [15]This is the way RFC 1583 specified point-to-point representation.
  It has three advantages: a) it does not require allocating a subnet
  to the point-to-point link, b) it tends to bias the routing so that
  packets destined for the point-to-point interface will actually be
  received over the interface (which is useful for diagnostic purposes)
  and c) it allows network bootstrapping of a neighbor, without
  requiring that the bootstrap program contain an OSPF implementation.

  [16]This is the more traditional point-to-point representation used
  by protocols such as RIP.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 156]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  [17]This clause covers the case: Inter-area routes are not summarized
  to the backbone.  This is because inter-area routes are always
  associated with the backbone area.

  [18]This clause is only invoked when a non-backbone Area A supports
  transit data traffic (i.e., has TransitCapability set to TRUE).  For
  example, in the area configuration of Figure 6, Area 2 can support
  transit traffic due to the configured virtual link between Routers
  RT10 and RT11. As a result, Router RT11 need only originate a single
  summary-LSA into Area 2 (having the collapsed destination N9-N11,H1),
  since all of Router RT11's other eligible routes have next hops
  belonging to Area 2 itself (and as such only need be advertised by
  other area border routers; in this case, Routers RT10 and RT7).

  [19]By keeping more information in the routing table, it is possible
  for an implementation to recalculate the shortest path tree for only
  a single area.  In fact, there are incremental algorithms that allow
  an implementation to recalculate only a portion of a single area's
  shortest path tree [Ref1]. However, these algorithms are beyond the
  scope of this specification.

  [20]This is how the Link state request list is emptied, which
  eventually causes the neighbor state to transition to Full.  See
  Section 10.9 for more details.

  [21]It should be a relatively rare occurrence for an LSA's LS age to
  reach MaxAge in this fashion.  Usually, the LSA will be replaced by a
  more recent instance before it ages out.

  [22]Strictly speaking, because of equal-cost multipath, the algorithm
  does not create a tree.  We continue to use the "tree" terminology
  because that is what occurs most often in the existing literature.

  [23]Note that the presence of any link back to V is sufficient; it
  need not be the matching half of the link under consideration from V
  to W. This is enough to ensure that, before data traffic flows
  between a pair of neighboring routers, their link state databases
  will be synchronized.

  [24]When the forwarding address is non-zero, it should point to a
  router belonging to another Autonomous System.  See Section 12.4.4
  for more details.









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 157]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


References

  [Ref1]  McQuillan, J., I. Richer and E. Rosen, "ARPANET Routing
          Algorithm Improvements", BBN Technical Report 3803, April
          1978.

  [Ref2]  Digital Equipment Corporation, "Information processing
          systems -- Data communications -- Intermediate System to
          Intermediate System Intra-Domain Routing Protocol", October
          1987.

  [Ref3]  McQuillan, J. et.al., "The New Routing Algorithm for the
          ARPANET", IEEE Transactions on Communications, May 1980.

  [Ref4]  Perlman, R., "Fault-Tolerant Broadcast of Routing
          Information", Computer Networks, December 1983.

  [Ref5]  Postel, J., "Internet Protocol", STD 5, RFC 791,
          USC/Information Sciences Institute, September 1981.

  [Ref6]  McKenzie, A., "ISO Transport Protocol specification ISO DP
          8073", RFC 905, ISO, April 1984.

  [Ref7]  Deering, S., "Host extensions for IP multicasting", STD 5,
          RFC 1112, Stanford University, May 1988.

  [Ref8]  McCloghrie, K., and M. Rose, "Management Information Base
          for network management of TCP/IP-based internets: MIB-II",
          STD 17, RFC 1213, Hughes LAN Systems, Performance Systems
          International, March 1991.

  [Ref9]  Moy, J., "OSPF Version 2", RFC 1583, Proteon, Inc., March
          1994.

  [Ref10] Fuller, V., T. Li, J. Yu, and K. Varadhan, "Classless
          Inter-Domain Routing (CIDR): an Address Assignment and
          Aggregation Strategy", RFC1519, BARRNet, cisco, MERIT,
          OARnet, September 1993.

  [Ref11] Reynolds, J., and J. Postel, "Assigned Numbers", STD 2, RFC
          1700, USC/Information Sciences Institute, October 1994.

  [Ref12] Almquist, P., "Type of Service in the Internet Protocol
          Suite", RFC 1349, July 1992.

  [Ref13] Leiner, B., et.al., "The DARPA Internet Protocol Suite", DDN
          Protocol Handbook, April 1985.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 158]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  [Ref14] Bradley, T., and C. Brown, "Inverse Address Resolution
          Protocol", RFC 1293, January 1992.

  [Ref15] deSouza, O., and M. Rodrigues, "Guidelines for Running OSPF
          Over Frame Relay Networks", RFC 1586, March 1994.

  [Ref16] Bellovin, S., "Security Problems in the TCP/IP Protocol
          Suite", ACM Computer Communications Review, Volume 19,
          Number 2, pp. 32-38, April 1989.

  [Ref17] Rivest, R., "The MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm", RFC 1321,
          April 1992.

  [Ref18] Moy, J., "Multicast Extensions to OSPF", RFC 1584, Proteon,
          Inc., March 1994.

  [Ref19] Coltun, R. and V. Fuller, "The OSPF NSSA Option", RFC 1587,
          RainbowBridge Communications, Stanford University, March
          1994.

  [Ref20] Ferguson, D., "The OSPF External Attributes LSA", work in
          progress.

  [Ref21] Moy, J., "Extending OSPF to Support Demand Circuits", RFC
          1793, Cascade, April 1995.

  [Ref22] Mogul, J. and S. Deering, "Path MTU Discovery", RFC 1191,
          DECWRL, Stanford University, November 1990.

  [Ref23] Rekhter, Y. and T. Li, "A Border Gateway Protocol 4 (BGP-
          4)", RFC 1771, T.J. Watson Research Center, IBM Corp., cisco
          Systems, March 1995.

  [Ref24] Hinden, R., "Internet Routing Protocol Standardization
          Criteria", BBN, October 1991.
















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 159]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A. OSPF data formats

  This appendix describes the format of OSPF protocol packets and OSPF
  LSAs.  The OSPF protocol runs directly over the IP network layer.
  Before any data formats are described, the details of the OSPF
  encapsulation are explained.

  Next the OSPF Options field is described.  This field describes
  various capabilities that may or may not be supported by pieces of
  the OSPF routing domain. The OSPF Options field is contained in OSPF
  Hello packets, Database Description packets and in OSPF LSAs.

  OSPF packet formats are detailed in Section A.3.  A description of
  OSPF LSAs appears in Section A.4.

A.1 Encapsulation of OSPF packets

  OSPF runs directly over the Internet Protocol's network layer.  OSPF
  packets are therefore encapsulated solely by IP and local data-link
  headers.

  OSPF does not define a way to fragment its protocol packets, and
  depends on IP fragmentation when transmitting packets larger than the
  network MTU. If necessary, the length of OSPF packets can be up to
  65,535 bytes (including the IP header). The OSPF packet types that
  are likely to be large (Database Description Packets, Link State
  Request, Link State Update, and Link State Acknowledgment packets)
  can usually be split into several separate protocol packets, without
  loss of functionality.  This is recommended; IP fragmentation should
  be avoided whenever possible. Using this reasoning, an attempt should
  be made to limit the sizes of OSPF packets sent over virtual links to
  576 bytes unless Path MTU Discovery is being performed (see [Ref22]).

  The other important features of OSPF's IP encapsulation are:

  o  Use of IP multicast.  Some OSPF messages are multicast, when
     sent over broadcast networks.  Two distinct IP multicast addresses
     are used.  Packets sent to these multicast addresses should never
     be forwarded; they are meant to travel a single hop only.  To
     ensure that these packets will not travel multiple hops, their IP
     TTL must be set to 1.










Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 160]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  AllSPFRouters
     This multicast address has been assigned the value 224.0.0.5. All
     routers running OSPF should be prepared to receive packets sent to
     this address.  Hello packets are always sent to this destination.
     Also, certain OSPF protocol packets are sent to this address
     during the flooding procedure.

  AllDRouters
     This multicast address has been assigned the value 224.0.0.6. Both
     the Designated Router and Backup Designated Router must be
     prepared to receive packets destined to this address.  Certain
     OSPF protocol packets are sent to this address during the flooding
     procedure.

  o   OSPF is IP protocol number 89.  This number has been registered
      with the Network Information Center.  IP protocol number
      assignments are documented in [Ref11].

  o   All OSPF routing protocol packets are sent using the normal
      service TOS value of binary 0000 defined in [Ref12].

  o   Routing protocol packets are sent with IP precedence set to
      Internetwork Control.  OSPF protocol packets should be given
      precedence over regular IP data traffic, in both sending and
      receiving.  Setting the IP precedence field in the IP header to
      Internetwork Control [Ref5] may help implement this objective.

























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 161]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.2 The Options field

  The OSPF Options field is present in OSPF Hello packets, Database
  Description packets and all LSAs.  The Options field enables OSPF
  routers to support (or not support) optional capabilities, and to
  communicate their capability level to other OSPF routers.  Through
  this mechanism routers of differing capabilities can be mixed within
  an OSPF routing domain.

  When used in Hello packets, the Options field allows a router to
  reject a neighbor because of a capability mismatch.  Alternatively,
  when capabilities are exchanged in Database Description packets a
  router can choose not to forward certain LSAs to a neighbor because
  of its reduced functionality.  Lastly, listing capabilities in LSAs
  allows routers to forward traffic around reduced functionality
  routers, by excluding them from parts of the routing table
  calculation.

  Five bits of the OSPF Options field have been assigned, although only
  one (the E-bit) is described completely by this memo. Each bit is
  described briefly below. Routers should reset (i.e. clear)
  unrecognized bits in the Options field when sending Hello packets or
  Database Description packets and when originating LSAs. Conversely,
  routers encountering unrecognized Option bits in received Hello
  Packets, Database Description packets or LSAs should ignore the
  capability and process the packet/LSA normally.

              +------------------------------------+
              | * | * | DC | EA | N/P | MC | E | * |
              +------------------------------------+

                          The Options field

  E-bit
     This bit describes the way AS-external-LSAs are flooded, as
     described in Sections 3.6, 9.5, 10.8 and 12.1.2 of this memo.

  MC-bit
     This bit describes whether IP multicast datagrams are forwarded
     according to the specifications in [Ref18].

  N/P-bit
     This bit describes the handling of Type-7 LSAs, as specified in
     [Ref19].

  EA-bit
     This bit describes the router's willingness to receive and
     forward External-Attributes-LSAs, as specified in [Ref20].



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 162]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  DC-bit
     This bit describes the router's handling of demand circuits, as
     specified in [Ref21].

A.3 OSPF Packet Formats

  There are five distinct OSPF packet types. All OSPF packet types
  begin with a standard 24 byte header.  This header is described
  first.  Each packet type is then described in a succeeding section.
  In these sections each packet's division into fields is displayed,
  and then the field definitions are enumerated.

  All OSPF packet types (other than the OSPF Hello packets) deal with
  lists of LSAs.  For example, Link State Update packets implement the
  flooding of LSAs throughout the OSPF routing domain.  Because of
  this, OSPF protocol packets cannot be parsed unless the format of
  LSAs is also understood.  The format of LSAs is described in Section
  A.4.

  The receive processing of OSPF packets is detailed in Section 8.2.
  The sending of OSPF packets is explained in Section 8.1.






























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 163]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.3.1 The OSPF packet header

  Every OSPF packet starts with a standard 24 byte header.  This header
  contains all the information necessary to determine whether the
  packet should be accepted for further processing.  This determination
  is described in Section 8.2 of the specification.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |   Version #   |     Type      |         Packet length         |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Router ID                            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                           Area ID                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |           Checksum            |             AuType            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+


  Version #
     The OSPF version number.  This specification documents version 2
     of the protocol.

  Type
     The OSPF packet types are as follows. See Sections A.3.2 through
     A.3.6 for details.

                 Type   Description
                 ________________________________
                 1      Hello
                 2      Database Description
                 3      Link State Request
                 4      Link State Update
                 5      Link State Acknowledgment


  Packet length
     The length of the OSPF protocol packet in bytes.  This length
     includes the standard OSPF header.

  Router ID
     The Router ID of the packet's source.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 164]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Area ID
     A 32 bit number identifying the area that this packet belongs
     to.  All OSPF packets are associated with a single area.  Most
     travel a single hop only.  Packets travelling over a virtual
     link are labelled with the backbone Area ID of 0.0.0.0.

  Checksum
     The standard IP checksum of the entire contents of the packet,
     starting with the OSPF packet header but excluding the 64-bit
     authentication field.  This checksum is calculated as the 16-bit
     one's complement of the one's complement sum of all the 16-bit
     words in the packet, excepting the authentication field.  If the
     packet's length is not an integral number of 16-bit words, the
     packet is padded with a byte of zero before checksumming.  The
     checksum is considered to be part of the packet authentication
     procedure; for some authentication types the checksum
     calculation is omitted.

  AuType
     Identifies the authentication procedure to be used for the
     packet.  Authentication is discussed in Appendix D of the
     specification.  Consult Appendix D for a list of the currently
     defined authentication types.

  Authentication
     A 64-bit field for use by the authentication scheme. See
     Appendix D for details.
























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 165]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.3.2 The Hello packet

  Hello packets are OSPF packet type 1.  These packets are sent
  periodically on all interfaces (including virtual links) in order to
  establish and maintain neighbor relationships.  In addition, Hello
  Packets are multicast on those physical networks having a multicast
  or broadcast capability, enabling dynamic discovery of neighboring
  routers.

  All routers connected to a common network must agree on certain
  parameters (Network mask, HelloInterval and RouterDeadInterval).
  These parameters are included in Hello packets, so that differences
  can inhibit the forming of neighbor relationships. A detailed
  explanation of the receive processing for Hello packets is presented
  in Section 10.5.  The sending of Hello packets is covered in Section
  9.5.


       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
     +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |   Version #   |       1       |         Packet length         |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Router ID                            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                           Area ID                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |           Checksum            |             AuType            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Network Mask                           |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         HelloInterval         |    Options    |    Rtr Pri    |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     RouterDeadInterval                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                      Designated Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                   Backup Designated Router                    |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Neighbor                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 166]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Network mask
     The network mask associated with this interface.  For example,
     if the interface is to a class B network whose third byte is
     used for subnetting, the network mask is 0xffffff00.

  Options
     The optional capabilities supported by the router, as documented
     in Section A.2.

  HelloInterval
     The number of seconds between this router's Hello packets.

  Rtr Pri
     This router's Router Priority.  Used in (Backup) Designated
     Router election.  If set to 0, the router will be ineligible to
     become (Backup) Designated Router.

  RouterDeadInterval
     The number of seconds before declaring a silent router down.

  Designated Router
     The identity of the Designated Router for this network, in the
     view of the sending router.  The Designated Router is identified
     here by its IP interface address on the network.  Set to 0.0.0.0
     if there is no Designated Router.

  Backup Designated Router
     The identity of the Backup Designated Router for this network,
     in the view of the sending router.  The Backup Designated Router
     is identified here by its IP interface address on the network.
     Set to 0.0.0.0 if there is no Backup Designated Router.

  Neighbor
     The Router IDs of each router from whom valid Hello packets have
     been seen recently on the network.  Recently means in the last
     RouterDeadInterval seconds.















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 167]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.3.3 The Database Description packet

  Database Description packets are OSPF packet type 2.  These packets
  are exchanged when an adjacency is being initialized.  They describe
  the contents of the link-state database.  Multiple packets may be
  used to describe the database.  For this purpose a poll-response
  procedure is used. One of the routers is designated to be the master,
  the other the slave.  The master sends Database Description packets
  (polls) which are acknowledged by Database Description packets sent
  by the slave (responses).  The responses are linked to the polls via
  the packets' DD sequence numbers.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |   Version #   |       2       |         Packet length         |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Router ID                            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                           Area ID                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |           Checksum            |             AuType            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         Interface MTU         |    Options    |0|0|0|0|0|I|M|MS
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     DD sequence number                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                             -+
      |                                                               |
      +-                      An LSA Header                          -+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                             -+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                             -+
      |                                                               |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |


  The format of the Database Description packet is very similar to both
  the Link State Request and Link State Acknowledgment packets.  The
  main part of all three is a list of items, each item describing a
  piece of the link-state database.  The sending of Database



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 168]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Description Packets is documented in Section 10.8. The reception of
  Database Description packets is documented in Section 10.6.

  Interface MTU
     The size in bytes of the largest IP datagram that can be sent out
     the associated interface, without fragmentation.  The MTUs of
     common Internet link types can be found in Table 7-1 of [Ref22].
     Interface MTU should be set to 0 in Database Description packets
     sent over virtual links.

  Options
     The optional capabilities supported by the router, as documented
     in Section A.2.

  I-bit
     The Init bit.  When set to 1, this packet is the first in the
     sequence of Database Description Packets.

  M-bit
     The More bit.  When set to 1, it indicates that more Database
     Description Packets are to follow.

  MS-bit
     The Master/Slave bit.  When set to 1, it indicates that the router
     is the master during the Database Exchange process.  Otherwise,
     the router is the slave.

  DD sequence number
     Used to sequence the collection of Database Description Packets.
     The initial value (indicated by the Init bit being set) should be
     unique.  The DD sequence number then increments until the complete
     database description has been sent.

  The rest of the packet consists of a (possibly partial) list of the
  link-state database's pieces.  Each LSA in the database is described
  by its LSA header. The LSA header is documented in Section A.4.1.  It
  contains all the information required to uniquely identify both the
  LSA and the LSA's current instance.













Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 169]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.3.4 The Link State Request packet

  Link State Request packets are OSPF packet type 3. After exchanging
  Database Description packets with a neighboring router, a router may
  find that parts of its link-state database are out-of-date.  The Link
  State Request packet is used to request the pieces of the neighbor's
  database that are more up-to-date.  Multiple Link State Request
  packets may need to be used.

  A router that sends a Link State Request packet has in mind the
  precise instance of the database pieces it is requesting. Each
  instance is defined by its LS sequence number, LS checksum, and LS
  age, although these fields are not specified in the Link State
  Request Packet itself.  The router may receive even more recent
  instances in response.

  The sending of Link State Request packets is documented in Section
  10.9.  The reception of Link State Request packets is documented in
  Section 10.7.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |   Version #   |       3       |         Packet length         |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Router ID                            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                           Area ID                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |           Checksum            |             AuType            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          LS type                              |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Link State ID                           |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     Advertising Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |

  Each LSA requested is specified by its LS type, Link State ID, and
  Advertising Router.  This uniquely identifies the LSA, but not its
  instance.  Link State Request packets are understood to be requests
  for the most recent instance (whatever that might be).




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 170]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.3.5 The Link State Update packet

  Link State Update packets are OSPF packet type 4.  These packets
  implement the flooding of LSAs.  Each Link State Update packet
  carries a collection of LSAs one hop further from their origin.
  Several LSAs may be included in a single packet.

  Link State Update packets are multicast on those physical networks
  that support multicast/broadcast.  In order to make the flooding
  procedure reliable, flooded LSAs are acknowledged in Link State
  Acknowledgment packets.  If retransmission of certain LSAs is
  necessary, the retransmitted LSAs are always carried by unicast Link
  State Update packets.  For more information on the reliable flooding
  of LSAs, consult Section 13.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |   Version #   |       4       |         Packet length         |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Router ID                            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                           Area ID                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |           Checksum            |             AuType            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                            # LSAs                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                            +-+
      |                             LSAs                              |
      +-                                                            +-+
      |                              ...                              |



  # LSAs
     The number of LSAs included in this update.

  The body of the Link State Update packet consists of a list of LSAs.
  Each LSA begins with a common 20 byte header, described in Section
  A.4.1. Detailed formats of the different types of LSAs are described
  in Section A.4.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 171]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.3.6 The Link State Acknowledgment packet

  Link State Acknowledgment Packets are OSPF packet type 5.  To make
  the flooding of LSAs reliable, flooded LSAs are explicitly
  acknowledged.  This acknowledgment is accomplished through the
  sending and receiving of Link State Acknowledgment packets.  Multiple
  LSAs can be acknowledged in a single Link State Acknowledgment
  packet.

  Depending on the state of the sending interface and the sender of the
  corresponding Link State Update packet, a Link State Acknowledgment
  packet is sent either to the multicast address AllSPFRouters, to the
  multicast address AllDRouters, or as a unicast.  The sending of Link
  State Acknowledgment packets is documented in Section 13.5.  The
  reception of Link State Acknowledgment packets is documented in
  Section 13.7.

  The format of this packet is similar to that of the Data Description
  packet.  The body of both packets is simply a list of LSA headers.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |   Version #   |       5       |         Packet length         |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Router ID                            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                           Area ID                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |           Checksum            |             AuType            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                       Authentication                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                             -+
      |                                                               |
      +-                         An LSA Header                       -+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                             -+
      |                                                               |
      +-                                                             -+
      |                                                               |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 172]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Each acknowledged LSA is described by its LSA header.  The LSA header
  is documented in Section A.4.1.  It contains all the information
  required to uniquely identify both the LSA and the LSA's current
  instance.

A.4 LSA formats

  This memo defines five distinct types of LSAs.  Each LSA begins with
  a standard 20 byte LSA header.  This header is explained in Section
  A.4.1.  Succeeding sections then diagram the separate LSA types.

  Each LSA describes a piece of the OSPF routing domain.  Every router
  originates a router-LSA.  In addition, whenever the router is elected
  Designated Router, it originates a network-LSA.  Other types of LSAs
  may also be originated (see Section 12.4). All LSAs are then flooded
  throughout the OSPF routing domain.  The flooding algorithm is
  reliable, ensuring that all routers have the same collection of LSAs.
  (See Section 13 for more information concerning the flooding
  algorithm).  This collection of LSAs is called the link-state
  database.

  From the link state database, each router constructs a shortest path
  tree with itself as root.  This yields a routing table (see Section
  11).  For the details of the routing table build process, see Section
  16.


























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 173]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.4.1 The LSA header

  All LSAs begin with a common 20 byte header.  This header contains
  enough information to uniquely identify the LSA (LS type, Link State
  ID, and Advertising Router).  Multiple instances of the LSA may exist
  in the routing domain at the same time.  It is then necessary to
  determine which instance is more recent.  This is accomplished by
  examining the LS age, LS sequence number and LS checksum fields that
  are also contained in the LSA header.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |            LS age             |    Options    |    LS type    |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Link State ID                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     Advertising Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     LS sequence number                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         LS checksum           |             length            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+


  LS age
     The time in seconds since the LSA was originated.

  Options
     The optional capabilities supported by the described portion of
     the routing domain.  OSPF's optional capabilities are documented
     in Section A.2.

  LS type
     The type of the LSA.  Each LSA type has a separate advertisement
     format.  The LSA types defined in this memo are as follows (see
     Section 12.1.3 for further explanation):


       LS Type   Description
       ___________________________________
       1         Router-LSAs
       2         Network-LSAs
       3         Summary-LSAs (IP network)
       4         Summary-LSAs (ASBR)
       5         AS-external-LSAs





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 174]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Link State ID
     This field identifies the portion of the internet environment
     that is being described by the LSA.  The contents of this field
     depend on the LSA's LS type.  For example, in network-LSAs the
     Link State ID is set to the IP interface address of the
     network's Designated Router (from which the network's IP address
     can be derived).  The Link State ID is further discussed in
     Section 12.1.4.

  Advertising Router
     The Router ID of the router that originated the LSA.  For
     example, in network-LSAs this field is equal to the Router ID of
     the network's Designated Router.

  LS sequence number
     Detects old or duplicate LSAs.  Successive instances of an LSA
     are given successive LS sequence numbers.  See Section 12.1.6
     for more details.

  LS checksum
     The Fletcher checksum of the complete contents of the LSA,
     including the LSA header but excluding the LS age field. See
     Section 12.1.7 for more details.

  length
     The length in bytes of the LSA.  This includes the 20 byte LSA
     header.
























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 175]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.4.2 Router-LSAs

  Router-LSAs are the Type 1 LSAs.  Each router in an area originates a
  router-LSA.  The LSA describes the state and cost of the router's
  links (i.e., interfaces) to the area.  All of the router's links to
  the area must be described in a single router-LSA. For details
  concerning the construction of router-LSAs, see Section 12.4.1.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |            LS age             |     Options   |       1       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Link State ID                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     Advertising Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     LS sequence number                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         LS checksum           |             length            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |    0    |V|E|B|        0      |            # links            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Link ID                              |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                         Link Data                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |     Type      |     # TOS     |            metric             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |      TOS      |        0      |          TOS  metric          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                          Link ID                              |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                         Link Data                             |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |


  In router-LSAs, the Link State ID field is set to the router's OSPF
  Router ID. Router-LSAs are flooded throughout a single area only.

  bit V
     When set, the router is an endpoint of one or more fully adjacent
     virtual links having the described area as Transit area (V is for
     virtual link endpoint).




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 176]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  bit E
     When set, the router is an AS boundary router (E is for external).

  bit B
     When set, the router is an area border router (B is for border).

  # links
     The number of router links described in this LSA.  This must be
     the total collection of router links (i.e., interfaces) to the
     area.

  The following fields are used to describe each router link (i.e.,
  interface). Each router link is typed (see the below Type field).
  The Type field indicates the kind of link being described. It may be
  a link to a transit network, to another router or to a stub network.
  The values of all the other fields describing a router link depend on
  the link's Type.  For example, each link has an associated 32-bit
  Link Data field. For links to stub networks this field specifies the
  network's IP address mask.  For other link types the Link Data field
  specifies the router interface's IP address.

  Type
     A quick description of the router link.  One of the following.
     Note that host routes are classified as links to stub networks
     with network mask of 0xffffffff.

        Type   Description
        __________________________________________________
        1      Point-to-point connection to another router
        2      Connection to a transit network
        3      Connection to a stub network
        4      Virtual link

  Link ID
     Identifies the object that this router link connects to.  Value
     depends on the link's Type.  When connecting to an object that
     also originates an LSA (i.e., another router or a transit
     network) the Link ID is equal to the neighboring LSA's Link
     State ID.  This provides the key for looking up the neighboring
     LSA in the link state database during the routing table
     calculation. See Section 12.2 for more details.










Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 177]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      Type   Link ID
      ______________________________________
      1      Neighboring router's Router ID
      2      IP address of Designated Router
      3      IP network/subnet number
      4      Neighboring router's Router ID

  Link Data
     Value again depends on the link's Type field. For connections to
     stub networks, Link Data specifies the network's IP address
     mask. For unnumbered point-to-point connections, it specifies
     the interface's MIB-II [Ref8] ifIndex value. For the other link
     types it specifies the router interface's IP address. This
     latter piece of information is needed during the routing table
     build process, when calculating the IP address of the next hop.
     See Section 16.1.1 for more details.

  # TOS
     The number of different TOS metrics given for this link, not
     counting the required link metric (referred to as the TOS 0
     metric in [Ref9]).  For example, if no additional TOS metrics
     are given, this field is set to 0.

  metric
     The cost of using this router link.

  Additional TOS-specific information may also be included, for
  backward compatibility with previous versions of the OSPF
  specification ([Ref9]). Within each link, and for each desired TOS,
  TOS TOS-specific link information may be encoded as follows:

  TOS IP  Type of Service that this metric refers to. The encoding of
     TOS in OSPF LSAs is described in Section 12.3.

  TOS metric
     TOS-specific metric information.















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 178]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.4.3 Network-LSAs

  Network-LSAs are the Type 2 LSAs.  A network-LSA is originated for
  each broadcast and NBMA network in the area which supports two or
  more routers.  The network-LSA is originated by the network's
  Designated Router. The LSA describes all routers attached to the
  network, including the Designated Router itself.  The LSA's Link
  State ID field lists the IP interface address of the Designated
  Router.

  The distance from the network to all attached routers is zero.  This
  is why metric fields need not be specified in the network-LSA.  For
  details concerning the construction of network-LSAs, see Section
  12.4.2.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |            LS age             |      Options  |      2        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Link State ID                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     Advertising Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     LS sequence number                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         LS checksum           |             length            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                         Network Mask                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Attached Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |


  Network Mask
     The IP address mask for the network.  For example, a class A
     network would have the mask 0xff000000.

  Attached Router
     The Router IDs of each of the routers attached to the network.
     Actually, only those routers that are fully adjacent to the
     Designated Router are listed.  The Designated Router includes
     itself in this list.  The number of routers included can be
     deduced from the LSA header's length field.






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 179]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.4.4 Summary-LSAs

  Summary-LSAs are the Type 3 and 4 LSAs.  These LSAs are originated by
  area border routers. Summary-LSAs describe inter-area destinations.
  For details concerning the construction of summary-LSAs, see Section
  12.4.3.

  Type 3 summary-LSAs are used when the destination is an IP network.
  In this case the LSA's Link State ID field is an IP network number
  (if necessary, the Link State ID can also have one or more of the
  network's "host" bits set; see Appendix E for details). When the
  destination is an AS boundary router, a Type 4 summary-LSA is used,
  and the Link State ID field is the AS boundary router's OSPF Router
  ID.  (To see why it is necessary to advertise the location of each
  ASBR, consult Section 16.4.)  Other than the difference in the Link
  State ID field, the format of Type 3 and 4 summary-LSAs is identical.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |            LS age             |     Options   |    3 or 4     |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Link State ID                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     Advertising Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     LS sequence number                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         LS checksum           |             length            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                         Network Mask                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |      0        |                  metric                       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |     TOS       |                TOS  metric                    |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |


  For stub areas, Type 3 summary-LSAs can also be used to describe a
  (per-area) default route.  Default summary routes are used in stub
  areas instead of flooding a complete set of external routes.  When
  describing a default summary route, the summary-LSA's Link State ID
  is always set to DefaultDestination (0.0.0.0) and the Network Mask is
  set to 0.0.0.0.






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 180]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Network Mask
     For Type 3 summary-LSAs, this indicates the destination network's
     IP address mask.  For example, when advertising the location of a
     class A network the value 0xff000000 would be used.  This field is
     not meaningful and must be zero for Type 4 summary-LSAs.

  metric
     The cost of this route.  Expressed in the same units as the
     interface costs in the router-LSAs.

  Additional TOS-specific information may also be included, for
  backward compatibility with previous versions of the OSPF
  specification ([Ref9]). For each desired TOS, TOS-specific
  information is encoded as follows:

  TOS IP Type of Service that this metric refers to. The encoding of
     TOS in OSPF LSAs is described in Section 12.3.

  TOS metric
     TOS-specific metric information.































Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 181]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


A.4.5 AS-external-LSAs

  AS-external-LSAs are the Type 5 LSAs.  These LSAs are originated by
  AS boundary routers, and describe destinations external to the AS.
  For details concerning the construction of AS-external-LSAs, see
  Section 12.4.3.

  AS-external-LSAs usually describe a particular external destination.
  For these LSAs the Link State ID field specifies an IP network number
  (if necessary, the Link State ID can also have one or more of the
  network's "host" bits set; see Appendix E for details).  AS-
  external-LSAs are also used to describe a default route.  Default
  routes are used when no specific route exists to the destination.
  When describing a default route, the Link State ID is always set to
  DefaultDestination (0.0.0.0) and the Network Mask is set to 0.0.0.0.

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |            LS age             |     Options   |      5        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                        Link State ID                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     Advertising Router                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                     LS sequence number                        |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |         LS checksum           |             length            |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                         Network Mask                          |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |E|     0       |                  metric                       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                      Forwarding address                       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                      External Route Tag                       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |E|    TOS      |                TOS  metric                    |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                      Forwarding address                       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                      External Route Tag                       |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                              ...                              |







Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 182]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Network Mask
     The IP address mask for the advertised destination.  For
     example, when advertising a class A network the mask 0xff000000
     would be used.

  bit E
     The type of external metric.  If bit E is set, the metric
     specified is a Type 2 external metric.  This means the metric is
     considered larger than any link state path.  If bit E is zero,
     the specified metric is a Type 1 external metric.  This means
     that it is expressed in the same units as the link state metric
     (i.e., the same units as interface cost).

  metric
     The cost of this route.  Interpretation depends on the external
     type indication (bit E above).

  Forwarding address
     Data traffic for the advertised destination will be forwarded to
     this address.  If the Forwarding address is set to 0.0.0.0, data
     traffic will be forwarded instead to the LSA's originator (i.e.,
     the responsible AS boundary router).

  External Route Tag
      A 32-bit field attached to each external route.  This is not
      used by the OSPF protocol itself.  It may be used to communicate
      information between AS boundary routers; the precise nature of
      such information is outside the scope of this specification.

  Additional TOS-specific information may also be included, for
  backward compatibility with previous versions of the OSPF
  specification ([Ref9]). For each desired TOS, TOS-specific
  information is encoded as follows:

  TOS The Type of Service that the following fields concern. The
     encoding of TOS in OSPF LSAs is described in Section 12.3.

  bit E
     For backward-compatibility with [Ref9].

  TOS metric
     TOS-specific metric information.

  Forwarding address
     For backward-compatibility with [Ref9].

  External Route Tag
     For backward-compatibility with [Ref9].



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 183]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


B. Architectural Constants

  Several OSPF protocol parameters have fixed architectural values.
  These parameters have been referred to in the text by names such as
  LSRefreshTime.  The same naming convention is used for the
  configurable protocol parameters.  They are defined in Appendix C.

  The name of each architectural constant follows, together with its
  value and a short description of its function.

  LSRefreshTime
     The maximum time between distinct originations of any particular
     LSA.  If the LS age field of one of the router's self-originated
     LSAs reaches the value LSRefreshTime, a new instance of the LSA is
     originated, even though the contents of the LSA (apart from the
     LSA header) will be the same.  The value of LSRefreshTime is set
     to 30 minutes.

  MinLSInterval
     The minimum time between distinct originations of any particular
     LSA.  The value of MinLSInterval is set to 5 seconds.

  MinLSArrival
     For any particular LSA, the minimum time that must elapse
     between reception of new LSA instances during flooding. LSA
     instances received at higher frequencies are discarded. The value
     of MinLSArrival is set to 1 second.

  MaxAge
     The maximum age that an LSA can attain. When an LSA's LS age field
     reaches MaxAge, it is reflooded in an attempt to flush the LSA
     from the routing domain (See Section 14). LSAs of age MaxAge are
     not used in the routing table calculation.  The value of MaxAge is
     set to 1 hour.

  CheckAge
     When the age of an LSA in the link state database hits a multiple
     of CheckAge, the LSA's checksum is verified.  An incorrect
     checksum at this time indicates a serious error.  The value of
     CheckAge is set to 5 minutes.

  MaxAgeDiff
     The maximum time dispersion that can occur, as an LSA is flooded
     throughout the AS.  Most of this time is accounted for by the LSAs
     sitting on router output queues (and therefore not aging) during
     the flooding process.  The value of MaxAgeDiff is set to 15
     minutes.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 184]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  LSInfinity
     The metric value indicating that the destination described by an
     LSA is unreachable. Used in summary-LSAs and AS-external-LSAs as
     an alternative to premature aging (see Section 14.1). It is
     defined to be the 24-bit binary value of all ones: 0xffffff.

  DefaultDestination
     The Destination ID that indicates the default route.  This route
     is used when no other matching routing table entry can be found.
     The default destination can only be advertised in AS-external-
     LSAs and in stub areas' type 3 summary-LSAs.  Its value is the IP
     address 0.0.0.0. Its associated Network Mask is also always
     0.0.0.0.

  InitialSequenceNumber
     The value used for LS Sequence Number when originating the first
     instance of any LSA. Its value is the signed 32-bit integer
     0x80000001.

  MaxSequenceNumber
     The maximum value that LS Sequence Number can attain.  Its value
     is the signed 32-bit integer 0x7fffffff.





























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 185]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


C. Configurable Constants

  The OSPF protocol has quite a few configurable parameters. These
  parameters are listed below.  They are grouped into general
  functional categories (area parameters, interface parameters, etc.).
  Sample values are given for some of the parameters.

  Some parameter settings need to be consistent among groups of
  routers.  For example, all routers in an area must agree on that
  area's parameters, and all routers attached to a network must agree
  on that network's IP network number and mask.

  Some parameters may be determined by router algorithms outside of
  this specification (e.g., the address of a host connected to the
  router via a SLIP line).  From OSPF's point of view, these items are
  still configurable.

C.1 Global parameters

  In general, a separate copy of the OSPF protocol is run for each
  area.  Because of this, most configuration parameters are defined on
  a per-area basis.  The few global configuration parameters are listed
  below.

  Router ID
      This is a 32-bit number that uniquely identifies the router in
      the Autonomous System.  One algorithm for Router ID assignment is
      to choose the largest or smallest IP address assigned to the
      router.  If a router's OSPF Router ID is changed, the router's
      OSPF software should be restarted before the new Router ID takes
      effect. Before restarting in order to change its Router ID, the
      router should flush its self-originated LSAs from the routing
      domain (see Section 14.1), or they will persist for up to MaxAge
      minutes.

  RFC1583Compatibility
      Controls the preference rules used in Section 16.4 when choosing
      among multiple AS-external-LSAs advertising the same destination.
      When set to "enabled", the preference rules remain those
      specified by RFC 1583 ([Ref9]). When set to "disabled", the
      preference rules are those stated in Section 16.4.1, which
      prevent routing loops when AS- external-LSAs for the same
      destination have been originated from different areas (see
      Section G.7). Set to "enabled" by default.







Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 186]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


      In order to minimize the chance of routing loops, all OSPF
      routers in an OSPF routing domain should have
      RFC1583Compatibility set identically. When there are routers
      present that have not been updated with the functionality
      specified in Section 16.4.1 of this memo, all routers should have
      RFC1583Compatibility set to "enabled". Otherwise, all routers
      should have RFC1583Compatibility set to "disabled", preventing
      all routing loops.

C.2 Area parameters

  All routers belonging to an area must agree on that area's
  configuration.  Disagreements between two routers will lead to an
  inability for adjacencies to form between them, with a resulting
  hindrance to the flow of routing protocol and data traffic.  The
  following items must be configured for an area:

  Area ID
      This is a 32-bit number that identifies the area.  The Area ID of
      0.0.0.0 is reserved for the backbone.  If the area represents a
      subnetted network, the IP network number of the subnetted network
      may be used for the Area ID.

  List of address ranges
      An OSPF area is defined as a list of address ranges. Each address
      range consists of the following items:

      [IP address, mask]
          Describes the collection of IP addresses contained in the
          address range. Networks and hosts are assigned to an area
          depending on whether their addresses fall into one of the
          area's defining address ranges.  Routers are viewed as
          belonging to multiple areas, depending on their attached
          networks' area membership.

      Status  Set to either Advertise or DoNotAdvertise. Routing
          information is condensed at area boundaries.  External to the
          area, at most a single route is advertised (via a summary-
          LSA) for each address range. The route is advertised if and
          only if the address range's Status is set to Advertise.
          Unadvertised ranges allow the existence of certain networks
          to be intentionally hidden from other areas. Status is set to
          Advertise by default.








Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 187]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


          As an example, suppose an IP subnetted network is to be its
          own OSPF area.  The area would be configured as a single
          address range, whose IP address is the address of the
          subnetted network, and whose mask is the natural class A, B,
          or C address mask. A single route would be advertised
          external to the area, describing the entire subnetted
          network.

      ExternalRoutingCapability
          Whether AS-external-LSAs will be flooded into/throughout the
          area.  If AS-external-LSAs are excluded from the area, the
          area is called a "stub".  Internal to stub areas, routing to
          external destinations will be based solely on a default
          summary route.  The backbone cannot be configured as a stub
          area.  Also, virtual links cannot be configured through stub
          areas.  For more information, see Section 3.6.

      StubDefaultCost
          If the area has been configured as a stub area, and the
          router itself is an area border router, then the
          StubDefaultCost indicates the cost of the default summary-LSA
          that the router should advertise into the area.

C.3 Router interface parameters

  Some of the configurable router interface parameters (such as IP
  interface address and subnet mask) actually imply properties of the
  attached networks, and therefore must be consistent across all the
  routers attached to that network.  The parameters that must be
  configured for a router interface are:

  IP interface address
      The IP protocol address for this interface.  This uniquely
      identifies the router over the entire internet.  An IP address is
      not required on point-to-point networks.  Such a point-to-point
      network is called "unnumbered".

  IP interface mask
      Also referred to as the subnet/network mask, this indicates the
      portion of the IP interface address that identifies the attached
      network.  Masking the IP interface address with the IP interface
      mask yields the IP network number of the attached network.  On
      point-to-point networks and virtual links, the IP interface mask
      is not defined. On these networks, the link itself is not
      assigned an IP network number, and so the addresses of each side
      of the link are assigned independently, if they are assigned at
      all.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 188]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Area ID
      The OSPF area to which the attached network belongs.

  Interface output cost
      The cost of sending a packet on the interface, expressed in the
      link state metric.  This is advertised as the link cost for this
      interface in the router's router-LSA. The interface output cost
      must always be greater than 0.

  RxmtInterval
      The number of seconds between LSA retransmissions, for
      adjacencies belonging to this interface.  Also used when
      retransmitting Database Description and Link State Request
      Packets.  This should be well over the expected round-trip delay
      between any two routers on the attached network.  The setting of
      this value should be conservative or needless retransmissions
      will result.  Sample value for a local area network: 5 seconds.

  InfTransDelay
      The estimated number of seconds it takes to transmit a Link State
      Update Packet over this interface.  LSAs contained in the update
      packet must have their age incremented by this amount before
      transmission.  This value should take into account the
      transmission and propagation delays of the interface. It must be
      greater than 0.  Sample value for a local area network: 1 second.

  Router Priority
      An 8-bit unsigned integer. When two routers attached to a network
      both attempt to become Designated Router, the one with the
      highest Router Priority takes precedence. If there is still a
      tie, the router with the highest Router ID takes precedence.  A
      router whose Router Priority is set to 0 is ineligible to become
      Designated Router on the attached network.  Router Priority is
      only configured for interfaces to broadcast and NBMA networks.

  HelloInterval
      The length of time, in seconds, between the Hello Packets that
      the router sends on the interface.  This value is advertised in
      the router's Hello Packets.  It must be the same for all routers
      attached to a common network. The smaller the HelloInterval, the
      faster topological changes will be detected; however, more OSPF
      routing protocol traffic will ensue.  Sample value for a X.25 PDN
      network: 30 seconds.  Sample value for a local area network: 10
      seconds.







Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 189]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  RouterDeadInterval
      After ceasing to hear a router's Hello Packets, the number of
      seconds before its neighbors declare the router down.  This is
      also advertised in the router's Hello Packets in their
      RouterDeadInterval field.  This should be some multiple of the
      HelloInterval (say 4).  This value again must be the same for all
      routers attached to a common network.

  AuType
      Identifies the authentication procedure to be used on the
      attached network.  This value must be the same for all routers
      attached to the network.  See Appendix D for a discussion of the
      defined authentication types.

  Authentication key
      This configured data allows the authentication procedure to
      verify OSPF protocol packets received over the interface.  For
      example, if the AuType indicates simple password, the
      Authentication key would be a clear 64-bit password.
      Authentication keys associated with the other OSPF authentication
      types are discussed in Appendix D.

C.4 Virtual link parameters

  Virtual links are used to restore/increase connectivity of the
  backbone.  Virtual links may be configured between any pair of area
  border routers having interfaces to a common (non-backbone) area.
  The virtual link appears as an unnumbered point-to-point link in the
  graph for the backbone.  The virtual link must be configured in both
  of the area border routers.

  A virtual link appears in router-LSAs (for the backbone) as if it
  were a separate router interface to the backbone.  As such, it has
  all of the parameters associated with a router interface (see Section
  C.3).  Although a virtual link acts like an unnumbered point-to-point
  link, it does have an associated IP interface address.  This address
  is used as the IP source in OSPF protocol packets it sends along the
  virtual link, and is set dynamically during the routing table build
  process.  Interface output cost is also set dynamically on virtual
  links to be the cost of the intra-area path between the two routers.
  The parameter RxmtInterval must be configured, and should be well
  over the expected round-trip delay between the two routers.  This may
  be hard to estimate for a virtual link; it is better to err on the
  side of making it too large.  Router Priority is not used on virtual
  links.






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 190]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  A virtual link is defined by the following two configurable
  parameters: the Router ID of the virtual link's other endpoint, and
  the (non-backbone) area through which the virtual link runs (referred
  to as the virtual link's Transit area).  Virtual links cannot be
  configured through stub areas.

C.5 NBMA network parameters

  OSPF treats an NBMA network much like it treats a broadcast network.
  Since there may be many routers attached to the network, a Designated
  Router is selected for the network.  This Designated Router then
  originates a network-LSA, which lists all routers attached to the
  NBMA network.

  However, due to the lack of broadcast capabilities, it may be
  necessary to use configuration parameters in the Designated Router
  selection.  These parameters will only need to be configured in those
  routers that are themselves eligible to become Designated Router
  (i.e., those router's whose Router Priority for the network is non-
  zero), and then only if no automatic procedure for discovering
  neighbors exists:

  List of all other attached routers
      The list of all other routers attached to the NBMA network.  Each
      router is listed by its IP interface address on the network.
      Also, for each router listed, that router's eligibility to become
      Designated Router must be defined.  When an interface to a NBMA
      network comes up, the router sends Hello Packets only to those
      neighbors eligible to become Designated Router, until the
      identity of the Designated Router is discovered.

  PollInterval
      If a neighboring router has become inactive (Hello Packets have
      not been seen for RouterDeadInterval seconds), it may still be
      necessary to send Hello Packets to the dead neighbor.  These
      Hello Packets will be sent at the reduced rate PollInterval,
      which should be much larger than HelloInterval.  Sample value for
      a PDN X.25 network: 2 minutes.

C.6 Point-to-MultiPoint network parameters

  On Point-to-MultiPoint networks, it may be necessary to configure the
  set of neighbors that are directly reachable over the Point-to-
  MultiPoint network. Each neighbor is identified by its IP address on
  the Point-to-MultiPoint network. Designated Routers are not elected
  on Point-to-MultiPoint networks, so the Designated Router eligibility
  of configured neighbors is undefined.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 191]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Alternatively, neighbors on Point-to-MultiPoint networks may be
  dynamically discovered by lower-level protocols such as Inverse ARP
  ([Ref14]).

C.7 Host route parameters

  Host routes are advertised in router-LSAs as stub networks with mask
  0xffffffff.  They indicate either router interfaces to point-to-point
  networks, looped router interfaces, or IP hosts that are directly
  connected to the router (e.g., via a SLIP line). For each host
  directly connected to the router, the following items must be
  configured:

  Host IP address
      The IP address of the host.

  Cost of link to host
      The cost of sending a packet to the host, in terms of the link
      state metric. However, since the host probably has only a single
      connection to the internet, the actual configured cost in many
      cases is unimportant (i.e., will have no effect on routing).

  Area ID
      The OSPF area to which the host belongs.



























Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 192]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


D. Authentication

  All OSPF protocol exchanges are authenticated.  The OSPF packet
  header (see Section A.3.1) includes an authentication type field, and
  64-bits of data for use by the appropriate authentication scheme
  (determined by the type field).

  The authentication type is configurable on a per-interface (or
  equivalently, on a per-network/subnet) basis.  Additional
  authentication data is also configurable on a per-interface basis.

  Authentication types 0, 1 and 2 are defined by this specification.
  All other authentication types are reserved for definition by the
  IANA ([email protected]).  The current list of authentication types is
  described below in Table 20.

         AuType       Description
         ___________________________________________
         0            Null authentication
         1            Simple password
         2            Cryptographic authentication
         All others   Reserved for assignment by the
                      IANA ([email protected])


                 Table 20: OSPF authentication types.


D.1 Null authentication

  Use of this authentication type means that routing exchanges over the
  network/subnet are not authenticated. The 64-bit authentication field
  in the OSPF header can contain anything; it is not examined on packet
  reception. When employing Null authentication, the entire contents of
  each OSPF packet (other than the 64-bit authentication field) are
  checksummed in order to detect data corruption.

D.2 Simple password authentication

  Using this authentication type, a 64-bit field is configured on a
  per-network basis.  All packets sent on a particular network must
  have this configured value in their OSPF header 64-bit authentication
  field.  This essentially serves as a "clear" 64- bit password. In
  addition, the entire contents of each OSPF packet (other than the
  64-bit authentication field) are checksummed in order to detect data
  corruption.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 193]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Simple password authentication guards against routers inadvertently
  joining the routing domain; each router must first be configured with
  its attached networks' passwords before it can participate in
  routing.  However, simple password authentication is vulnerable to
  passive attacks currently widespread in the Internet (see [Ref16]).
  Anyone with physical access to the network can learn the password and
  compromise the security of the OSPF routing domain.

D.3 Cryptographic authentication

  Using this authentication type, a shared secret key is configured in
  all routers attached to a common network/subnet.  For each OSPF
  protocol packet, the key is used to generate/verify a "message
  digest" that is appended to the end of the OSPF packet. The message
  digest is a one-way function of the OSPF protocol packet and the
  secret key. Since the secret key is never sent over the network in
  the clear, protection is provided against passive attacks.

  The algorithms used to generate and verify the message digest are
  specified implicitly by the secret key. This specification completely
  defines the use of OSPF Cryptographic authentication when the MD5
  algorithm is used.

  In addition, a non-decreasing sequence number is included in each
  OSPF protocol packet to protect against replay attacks.  This
  provides long term protection; however, it is still possible to
  replay an OSPF packet until the sequence number changes. To implement
  this feature, each neighbor data structure

       0                   1                   2                   3
       0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |              0                |    Key ID     | Auth Data Len |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+
      |                 Cryptographic sequence number                 |
      +-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+-+

             Figure 18: Usage of the Authentication field
             in the OSPF packet header when Cryptographic
                      Authentication is employed

  contains a new field called the "cryptographic sequence number".
  This field is initialized to zero, and is also set to zero whenever
  the neighbor's state transitions to "Down". Whenever an OSPF packet
  is accepted as authentic, the cryptographic sequence number is set to
  the received packet's sequence number.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 194]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  This specification does not provide a rollover procedure for the
  cryptographic sequence number. When the cryptographic sequence number
  that the router is sending hits the maximum value, the router should
  reset the cryptographic sequence number that it is sending back to 0.
  After this is done, the router's neighbors will reject the router's
  OSPF packets for a period of RouterDeadInterval, and then the router
  will be forced to reestablish all adjacencies over the interface.
  However, it is expected that many implementations will use "seconds
  since reboot" (or "seconds since 1960", etc.) as the cryptographic
  sequence number. Such a choice will essentially prevent rollover,
  since the cryptographic sequence number field is 32 bits in length.

  The OSPF Cryptographic authentication option does not provide
  confidentiality.

  When cryptographic authentication is used, the 64-bit Authentication
  field in the standard OSPF packet header is redefined as shown in
  Figure 18. The new field definitions are as follows:

  Key ID
      This field identifies the algorithm and secret key used to create
      the message digest appended to the OSPF packet. Key Identifiers
      are unique per-interface (or equivalently, per- subnet).

  Auth Data Len
      The length in bytes of the message digest appended to the OSPF
      packet.

  Cryptographic sequence number
      An unsigned 32-bit non-decreasing sequence number. Used to guard
      against replay attacks.

  The message digest appended to the OSPF packet is not actually
  considered part of the OSPF protocol packet: the message digest is
  not included in the OSPF header's packet length, although it is
  included in the packet's IP header length field.

  Each key is identified by the combination of interface and Key ID. An
  interface may have multiple keys active at any one time.  This
  enables smooth transition from one key to another. Each key has four
  time constants associated with it. These time constants can be
  expressed in terms of a time-of-day clock, or in terms of a router's
  local clock (e.g., number of seconds since last reboot):

  KeyStartAccept
      The time that the router will start accepting packets that
      have been created with the given key.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 195]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  KeyStartGenerate
      The time that the router will start using the key for packet
      generation.

  KeyStopGenerate
      The time that the router will stop using the key for packet
      generation.

  KeyStopAccept
      The time that the router will stop accepting packets that
      have been created with the given key.

  In order to achieve smooth key transition, KeyStartAccept should be
  less than KeyStartGenerate and KeyStopGenerate should be less than
  KeyStopAccept. If KeyStopGenerate and KeyStopAccept are left
  unspecified, the key's lifetime is infinite. When a new key replaces
  an old, the KeyStartGenerate time for the new key must be less than
  or equal to the KeyStopGenerate time of the old key.

  Key storage should persist across a system restart, warm or cold, to
  avoid operational issues. In the event that the last key associated
  with an interface expires, it is unacceptable to revert to an
  unauthenticated condition, and not advisable to disrupt routing.
  Therefore, the router should send a "last authentication key
  expiration" notification to the network manager and treat the key as
  having an infinite lifetime until the lifetime is extended, the key
  is deleted by network management, or a new key is configured.

D.4 Message generation

  After building the contents of an OSPF packet, the authentication
  procedure indicated by the sending interface's Autype value is called
  before the packet is sent. The authentication procedure modifies the
  OSPF packet as follows.

D.4.1 Generating Null authentication

  When using Null authentication, the packet is modified as follows:

  (1) The Autype field in the standard OSPF header is set to
      0.










Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 196]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (2) The checksum field in the standard OSPF header is set to
      the standard IP checksum of the entire contents of the packet,
      starting with the OSPF packet header but excluding the 64-bit
      authentication field.  This checksum is calculated as the 16-bit
      one's complement of the one's complement sum of all the 16-bit
      words in the packet, excepting the authentication field.  If the
      packet's length is not an integral number of 16-bit words, the
      packet is padded with a byte of zero before checksumming.

D.4.2 Generating Simple password authentication

  When using Simple password authentication, the packet is modified as
  follows:

  (1) The Autype field in the standard OSPF header is set to 1.

  (2) The checksum field in the standard OSPF header is set to the
      standard IP checksum of the entire contents of the packet,
      starting with the OSPF packet header but excluding the 64-bit
      authentication field.  This checksum is calculated as the 16-bit
      one's complement of the one's complement sum of all the 16-bit
      words in the packet, excepting the authentication field.  If the
      packet's length is not an integral number of 16-bit words, the
      packet is padded with a byte of zero before checksumming.

  (3) The 64-bit authentication field in the OSPF packet header
      is set to the 64-bit password (i.e., authentication key) that has
      been configured for the interface.

D.4.3 Generating Cryptographic authentication

  When using Cryptographic authentication, there may be multiple keys
  configured for the interface. In this case, among the keys that are
  valid for message generation (i.e, that have KeyStartGenerate <=
  current time < KeyStopGenerate) choose the one with the most recent
  KeyStartGenerate time. Using this key, modify the packet as follows:

  (1) The Autype field in the standard OSPF header is set to
      2.

  (2) The checksum field in the standard OSPF header is not
      calculated, but is instead set to 0.

  (3) The Key ID (see Figure 18) is set to the chosen key's
      Key ID.






Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 197]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  (4) The Auth Data Len field is set to the length in bytes of
      the message digest that will be appended to the OSPF packet. When
      using MD5 as the authentication algorithm, Auth Data Len will be
      16.

  (5) The 32-bit Cryptographic sequence number (see Figure 18)
      is set to a non-decreasing value (i.e., a value at least as large
      as the last value sent out the interface).  The precise values to
      use in the cryptographic sequence number field are
      implementation-specific.  For example, it may be based on a
      simple counter, or be based on the system's clock.

  (6) The message digest is then calculated and appended to
      the OSPF packet.  The authentication algorithm to be used in
      calculating the digest is indicated by the key itself.  Input to
      the authentication algorithm consists of the OSPF packet and the
      secret key. When using MD5 as the authentication algorithm, the
      message digest calculation proceeds as follows:

         (a) The 16 byte MD5 key is appended to the OSPF packet.

         (b) Trailing pad and length fields are added, as specified in
             [Ref17].

         (c) The MD5 authentication algorithm is run over the
             concatenation of the OSPF packet, secret key, pad and
             length fields, producing a 16 byte message digest (see
             [Ref17]).

         (d) The MD5 digest is written over the OSPF key (i.e.,
             appended to the original OSPF packet). The digest is not
             counted in the OSPF packet's length field, but is included
             in the packet's IP length field. Any trailing pad or
             length fields beyond the digest are not counted or
             transmitted.

D.5 Message verification

  When an OSPF packet has been received on an interface, it must be
  authenticated. The authentication procedure is indicated by the
  setting of Autype in the standard OSPF packet header, which matches
  the setting of Autype for the receiving OSPF interface.

  If an OSPF protocol packet is accepted as authentic, processing of
  the packet continues as specified in Section 8.2. Packets which fail
  authentication are discarded.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 198]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


D.5.1 Verifying Null authentication

  When using Null authentication, the checksum field in the OSPF header
  must be verified. It must be set to the 16-bit one's complement of
  the one's complement sum of all the 16-bit words in the packet,
  excepting the authentication field.  (If the packet's length is not
  an integral number of 16-bit words, the packet is padded with a byte
  of zero before checksumming.)

D.5.2 Verifying Simple password authentication

  When using Simple password authentication, the received OSPF packet
  is authenticated as follows:

      (1) The checksum field in the OSPF header must be verified.
          It must be set to the 16-bit one's complement of the
          one's complement sum of all the 16-bit words in the
          packet, excepting the authentication field.  (If the
          packet's length is not an integral number of 16-bit
          words, the packet is padded with a byte of zero before
          checksumming.)

      (2) The 64-bit authentication field in the OSPF packet
          header must be equal to the 64-bit password (i.e.,
          authentication key) that has been configured for the
          interface.

D.5.3 Verifying Cryptographic authentication

  When using Cryptographic authentication, the received OSPF packet is
  authenticated as follows:

      (1) Locate the receiving interface's configured key having
          Key ID equal to that specified in the received OSPF
          packet (see Figure 18). If the key is not found, or if
          the key is not valid for reception (i.e., current time <
          KeyStartAccept or current time >= KeyStopAccept), the
          OSPF packet is discarded.

      (2) If the cryptographic sequence number found in the OSPF
          header (see Figure 18) is less than the cryptographic
          sequence number recorded in the sending neighbor's data
          structure, the OSPF packet is discarded.

      (3) Verify the appended message digest in the following
          steps:

     (a) The received digest is set aside.



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 199]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


     (b) A new digest is calculated, as specified in Step 6
         of Section D.4.3.

     (c) The calculated and received digests are compared. If
         they do not match, the OSPF packet is discarded. If
         they do match, the OSPF protocol packet is accepted
         as authentic, and the "cryptographic sequence
         number" in the neighbor's data structure is set to
         the sequence number found in the packet's OSPF
         header.









































Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 200]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


E. An algorithm for assigning Link State IDs

  The Link State ID in AS-external-LSAs and summary-LSAs is usually set
  to the described network's IP address. However, if necessary one or
  more of the network's host bits may be set in the Link State ID.
  This allows the router to originate separate LSAs for networks having
  the same address, yet different masks. Such networks can occur in the
  presence of supernetting and subnet 0s (see [Ref10]).

  This appendix gives one possible algorithm for setting the host bits
  in Link State IDs. The choice of such an algorithm is a local
  decision. Separate routers are free to use different algorithms,
  since the only LSAs affected are the ones that the router itself
  originates. The only requirement on the algorithms used is that the
  network's IP address should be used as the Link State ID whenever
  possible; this maximizes interoperability with OSPF implementations
  predating RFC 1583.

  The algorithm below is stated for AS-external-LSAs.  This is only for
  clarity; the exact same algorithm can be used for summary-LSAs.
  Suppose that the router wishes to originate an AS-external-LSA for a
  network having address NA and mask NM1. The following steps are then
  used to determine the LSA's Link State ID:

   (1) Determine whether the router is already originating an AS-
       external-LSA with Link State ID equal to NA (in such an LSA the
       router itself will be listed as the LSA's Advertising Router).
       If not, the Link State ID is set equal to NA and the algorithm
       terminates. Otherwise,

   (2) Obtain the network mask from the body of the already existing
       AS-external-LSA. Call this mask NM2. There are then two cases:

       o   NM1 is longer (i.e., more specific) than NM2. In this case,
           set the Link State ID in the new LSA to be the network
           [NA,NM1] with all the host bits set (i.e., equal to NA or'ed
           together with all the bits that are not set in NM1, which is
           network [NA,NM1]'s broadcast address).

       o   NM2 is longer than NM1. In this case, change the existing
           LSA (having Link State ID of NA) to reference the new
           network [NA,NM1] by incrementing the sequence number,
           changing the mask in the body to NM1 and inserting the cost
           of the new network. Then originate a new LSA for the old
           network [NA,NM2], with Link State ID equal to NA or'ed
           together with the bits that are not set in NM2 (i.e.,
           network [NA,NM2]'s broadcast address).




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 201]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The above algorithm assumes that all masks are contiguous; this
  ensures that when two networks have the same address, one mask is
  more specific than the other. The algorithm also assumes that no
  network exists having an address equal to another network's broadcast
  address. Given these two assumptions, the above algorithm always
  produces unique Link State IDs. The above algorithm can also be
  reworded as follows: When originating an AS-external-LSA, try to use
  the network number as the Link State ID.  If that produces a
  conflict, examine the two networks in conflict. One will be a subset
  of the other. For the less specific network, use the network number
  as the Link State ID and for the more specific use the network's
  broadcast address instead (i.e., flip all the "host" bits to 1).  If
  the most specific network was originated first, this will cause you
  to originate two LSAs at once.

  As an example of the algorithm, consider its operation when the
  following sequence of events occurs in a single router (Router A).

   (1) Router A wants to originate an AS-external-LSA for
       [10.0.0.0,255.255.255.0]:

       (a) A Link State ID of 10.0.0.0 is used.

   (2) Router A then wants to originate an AS-external-LSA for
       [10.0.0.0,255.255.0.0]:

       (a) The LSA for [10.0.0,0,255.255.255.0] is reoriginated using a
           new Link State ID of 10.0.0.255.

       (b) A Link State ID of 10.0.0.0 is used for
           [10.0.0.0,255.255.0.0].

   (3) Router A then wants to originate an AS-external-LSA for
       [10.0.0.0,255.0.0.0]:

       (a) The LSA for [10.0.0.0,255.255.0.0] is reoriginated using a
           new Link State ID of 10.0.255.255.

       (b) A Link State ID of 10.0.0.0 is used for
           [10.0.0.0,255.0.0.0].

       (c) The network [10.0.0.0,255.255.255.0] keeps its Link State ID
           of 10.0.0.255.








Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 202]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


F. Multiple interfaces to the same network/subnet

  There are at least two ways to support multiple physical interfaces
  to the same IP subnet. Both methods will interoperate with
  implementations of RFC 1583 (and of course this memo). The two
  methods are sketched briefly below. An assumption has been made that
  each interface has been assigned a separate IP address (otherwise,
  support for multiple interfaces is more of a link-level or ARP issue
  than an OSPF issue).

  Method 1:
    Run the entire OSPF functionality over both interfaces, sending and
    receiving hellos, flooding, supporting separate interface and
    neighbor FSMs for each interface, etc. When doing this all other
    routers on the subnet will treat the two interfaces as separate
    neighbors, since neighbors are identified (on broadcast and NBMA
    networks) by their IP address.

    Method 1 has the following disadvantages:

    (1) You increase the total number of neighbors and adjacencies.

    (2) You lose the bidirectionality test on both interfaces, since
        bidirectionality is based on Router ID.

    (3) You have to consider both interfaces together during the
        Designated Router election, since if you declare both to be
        DR simultaneously you can confuse the tie-breaker (which is
        Router ID).

  Method 2:
    Run OSPF over only one interface (call it the primary interface),
    but include both the primary and secondary interfaces in your
    Router-LSA.

    Method 2 has the following disadvantages:

    (1) You lose the bidirectionality test on the secondary
        interface.

    (2) When the primary interface fails, you need to promote the
        secondary interface to primary status.









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 203]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


G. Differences from RFC 1583

  This section documents the differences between this memo and RFC
  1583.  All differences are backward-compatible. Implementations of
  this memo and of RFC 1583 will interoperate.

G.1 Enhancements to OSPF authentication

  An additional OSPF authentication type has been added: the
  Cryptographic authentication type. This has been defined so that any
  arbitrary "Keyed Message Digest" algorithm can be used for packet
  authentication. Operation using the MD5 algorithm is completely
  specified (see Appendix D).

  A number of other changes were also made to OSPF packet
  authentication, affecting the following Sections:

  o   The authentication type is now specified per-interface,
      rather than per-area (Sections 6, 9, C.2 and C.3).

  o   The OSPF packet header checksum is now considered part of
      the authentication procedure, and so has been moved out of the
      packet send and receive logic (Sections 8.1 and 8.2) and into the
      description of authentication types (Appendix D).

  o   In Appendix D, sections detailing message generation and
      message verification have been added.

  o   For the OSPF Cryptographic authentication type, a discussion
      of key management, including the requirement for simultaneous
      support of multiple keys, key lifetimes and smooth key
      transition, has been added to Appendix D.

G.2 Addition of Point-to-MultiPoint interface

  This memo adds an additional method for running OSPF over non-
  broadcast networks: the Point-to-Multipoint network. To implement
  this addition, the language of RFC 1583 has been altered slightly.
  References to "multi-access" networks have been deleted. The term
  "non-broadcast networks" is now used to describe networks which can
  connect many routers, but which do not natively support
  broadcast/multicast (such as a public Frame relay network).  Over
  non-broadcast networks, there are two options for running OSPF:
  modelling them as "NBMA networks" or as "Point-to-MultiPoint
  networks".  NBMA networks require full mesh connectivity between
  routers; when employing NBMA networks in the presence of partial mesh
  connectivity, multiple NBMA networks must be configured, as described
  in [Ref15].  In contrast, Point-to-Multipoint networks have been



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 204]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  designed to work simply and naturally when faced with partial mesh
  connectivity.

  The addition of Point-to-MultiPoint networks has impacted the text in
  many places, which are briefly summarized below:

  o   Section 2 describing the OSPF link-state database has been
      split into additional subsections, with one of the subsections
      (Section 2.1.1) describing the differing map representations of
      the two non-broadcast network options.  This subsection also
      contrasts the NBMA network and Point- to-MultiPoint network
      options, and describes the situations when one is preferable to
      the other.

  o   In contrast to NBMA networks, Point-to-MultiPoint networks
      have the following properties. Adjacencies are established
      between all neighboring routers (Sections 4, 7.1, 7.5, 9.5 and
      10.4). There is no Designated Router or Backup Designated Router
      for a Point-to-MultiPoint network (Sections 7.3 and 7.4). No
      network-LSA is originated for Point-to-MultiPoint networks
      (Sections 12.4.2 and A.4.3).  Router Priority is not configured
      for Point-to-MultiPoint interfaces, nor for neighbors on Point-
      to-MultiPoint networks (Sections C.3 and C.6).

  o   The Interface FSM for a Point-to-MultiPoint interface is
      identical to that used for point-to-point interfaces. Two states
      are possible: "Down" and "Point-to-Point" (Section 9.3).

  o   When originating a router-LSA, and Point-to-MultiPoint
      interface is reported as a collection of "point-to-point links"
      to all of the interface's adjacent neighbors, together with a
      single stub link advertising the interface's IP address with a
      cost of 0 (Section 12.4.1.4).

  o   When flooding out a non-broadcast interface (when either in
      NBMA or Point-to-MultiPoint mode) the Link State Update or Link
      State Acknowledgment packet must be replicated in order to be
      sent to each of the interface's neighbors (see Sections 13.3 and
      13.5).

G.3 Support for overlapping area ranges

  RFC 1583 requires that all networks falling into a given area range
  actually belong to a single area. This memo relaxes that restriction.
  This is useful in the following example. Suppose that [10.0.0.0,
  255.0.0.0] is carved up into subnets. Most of these subnets are
  assigned to a single OSPF area (call it Area X), while a few subnets
  are assigned to other areas. In order to get this configuration to



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 205]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  work with RFC 1583, you must not summarize the subnets of Area X with
  the single range [10.0.0.0, 255.0.0.0], because then the subnets of
  10.0.0.0 belonging to other areas would become unreachable. However,
  with this memo you can summarize the subnets in Area X, provided that
  the subnets belonging to other areas are not summarized.

  Implementation details for this change can be found in Sections 11.1
  and 16.2.

G.4 A modification to the flooding algorithm

  The OSPF flooding algorithm has been modified as follows. When a Link
  State Update Packet is received that contains an LSA instance which
  is actually less recent than the the router's current database copy,
  the router will now in most cases respond by flooding back its
  database copy. This is in contrast to the RFC 1583 behavior, which
  was to simply throw the received LSA away.

  Detailed description of the change can be found in Step 8 of Section
  13.

  This change improves MaxAge processing. There are times when MaxAge
  LSAs stay in a router's database for extended intervals: 1) when they
  are stuck in a retransmission queue on a slow link or 2) when a
  router is not properly flushing them from its database, due to
  software bugs. The prolonged existence of these MaxAge LSAs can
  inhibit the flooding of new instances of the LSA. New instances
  typically start with LS sequence number equal to
  InitialSequenceNumber, and are treated as less recent (and hence were
  discarded according to RFC 1583) by routers still holding MaxAge
  instances. However, with the above change to flooding, a router
  holding a MaxAge instance will flood back the MaxAge instance. When
  this flood reaches the LSA's originator, it will then pick the next
  highest LS sequence number and reflood, overwriting the MaxAge
  instance.

G.5 Introduction of the MinLSArrival constant

  OSPF limits the frequency that new instances of any particular LSA
  can be accepted during flooding. This is extra protection, just in
  case a neighboring router is violating the mandated limit on LSA
  (re)originations (namely, one per LSA in any MinLSInterval).









Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 206]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  In RFC 1583, the frequency at which new LSA instances were accepted
  was also set equal to once every MinLSInterval seconds.  However, in
  some circumstances this led to unwanted link state retransmissions,
  even when the LSA originator was obeying the MinLSInterval limit on
  originations. This was due to either 1) choice of clock granularity
  in some OSPF implementations or 2) differing clock speed in
  neighboring routers.

  To alleviate this problem, the frequency at which new LSA instances
  are accepted during flooding has now been increased to once every
  MinLSArrival seconds, whose value is set to 1.  This change is
  reflected in Steps 5a and 5d of Section 13, and in Appendix B.

G.6 Optionally advertising point-to-point links as subnets

  When describing a point-to-point interface in its router-LSA, a
  router may now advertise a stub link to the point-to-point network's
  subnet. This is specified as an alternative to the RFC 1583 behavior,
  which is to advertise a stub link to the neighbor's IP address. See
  Sections 12.4.1 and 12.4.1.1 for details.

G.7 Advertising same external route from multiple areas

  This document fixes routing loops which can occur in RFC 1583 when
  the same external destination is advertised by AS boundary routers in
  separate areas. There are two manifestations of this problem. The
  first, discovered by Dennis Ferguson, occurs when an aggregated
  forwarding address is in use. In this case, the desirability of the
  forwarding address can change for the worse as a packet crosses an
  area aggregation boundary on the way to the forwarding address, which
  in turn can cause the preference of AS-external-LSAs to change,
  resulting in a routing loop.

  The second manifestation was discovered by Richard Woundy. It is
  caused by an incomplete application of OSPF's preference of intra-
  area routes over inter-area routes: paths to any given
  ASBR/forwarding address are selected first based on intra-area
  preference, while the comparison between separate ASBRs/forwarding
  addresses is driven only by cost, ignoring intra-area preference. His
  example is replicated in Figure 19.  Both router A3 and router B3 are
  originating an AS-external-LSA for 10.0.0.0/8, with the same type 2
  metric. Router A1 selects B1 as its next hop towards 10.0.0.0/8,
  based on shorter cost to ASBR B3 (via B1->B2->B3). However, the
  shorter route to B3 is not available to B1, due to B1's preference
  for the (higher cost) intra-area route to B3 through Area A. This
  leads B1 to select A1 as its next hop to 10.0.0.0/8, resulting in a
  routing loop.




Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 207]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  The following two changes have been made to prevent these routing
  loops:

  o   When originating a type 3 summary-LSA for a configured area
      address range, the cost of the summary-LSA is now set to the
      maximum cost of the range's component networks (instead of the
      previous algorithm which set the cost to the minimum component
      cost).  This change affects Sections 3.5 and 12.4.3, Figures 7
      and 8, and Tables 6 and 13.

  o   The preference rules for choosing among multiple AS-
      external-LSAs have been changed. Where previously cost was the
      only determining factor, now the preference is driven first by
      type of path (intra-area or inter-area, through non-backbone area
      or through backbone) to the ASBR/forwarding address, using cost
      only to break ties. This change affects Sections 16.4 and 16.4.1.

  After implementing this change, the example in Figure 19 is modified
  as follows. Router A1 now chooses A3 as the next

                             10.0.0.0/8
                             ----------
                                  |
                               +----+
                               | XX |
                               +----+
                  RIP          /    \        RIP
          ---------------------      --------------------
          !                                             !
          !                                             !
        +----+      +----+       1       +----+......+----+....
        | A3 |------| A1 |---------------| B1 |------| B3 |   .
        +----+   6  +----+               +----+  8   +----+   .
                                          1|  .         /     .
                      OSPF backbone        |  .        /      .
                                         +----+  2    /       .
                                         | B2 |-------  Area A.
                                         +----+................

               Figure 19: Example routing loop when the
           same external route is advertised from multiple
                                areas

  hop to 10.0.0.0/8, while B1 chooses B3 as next hop. The reason for
  both choices is that ASBRs/forwarding addresses are now chosen based
  first on intra-area preference, and then by cost.





Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 208]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  Unfortunately, this change is not backward compatible. While the
  change prevents routing loops when all routers run the new preference
  rules, it can actually create routing loops when some routers are
  running the new preference rules and other routers implement RFC
  1583.  For this reason, a new configuration parameter has been added:
  RFC1583Compatibility. Only when RFC1583Compatibility is set to
  "disabled" will the new preference rules take effect. See Appendix C
  for more details.

G.8 Retransmission of initial Database Description packets

  This memo allows retransmission of initial Database Description
  packets, without resetting the state of the adjacency. In some
  environments, retransmission of the initial Database Description
  packet may be unavoidable. For example, the link delay incurred by a
  satellite link may exceed the value configured for an interface's
  RxmtInterval. In RFC 1583 such an environment prevents a full
  adjacency from ever forming.

  In this memo, changes have been made in the reception of Database
  Description packets so that retransmitted initial Database
  Description packets are treated identically to any other
  retransmitted Database Description packets. See Section 10.6 for
  details.

G.9 Detecting interface MTU mismatches

  When two neighboring routers have a different interface MTU for their
  common network segment, serious problems can ensue: large packets are
  prevented from being successfully transferred from one router to the
  other, impairing OSPF's flooding algorithm and possibly creating
  "black holes" for user data traffic.

  This memo provides a fix for the interface MTU mismatch problem by
  advertising the interface MTU in Database Description packets. When a
  router receives a Database description packet advertising an MTU
  larger than the router can receive, the router drops the Database
  Description packet. This prevents an adjacency from forming, telling
  OSPF flooding and user data traffic to avoid the connection between
  the two routers. For more information, see Sections 10.6, 10.8, and
  A.3.3.

G.10 Deleting the TOS routing option

  The TOS routing option has been deleted from OSPF. This action was
  required by the Internet standards process ([Ref24]), due to lack of
  implementation experience with OSPF's TOS routing.  However, for
  backward compatibility the formats of OSPF's various LSAs remain



Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 209]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


  unchanged, maintaining the ability to specify TOS metrics in router-
  LSAs, summary-LSAs, ASBR-summary-LSAs, and AS-external-LSAs (see
  Sections 12.3, A.4.2, A.4.4, and A.4.5).

  To see OSPF's original TOS routing design, consult [Ref9].

Security Considerations

  All OSPF protocol exchanges are authenticated. OSPF supports multiple
  types of authentication; the type of authentication in use can be
  configured on a per network segment basis. One of OSPF's
  authentication types, namely the Cryptographic authentication option,
  is believed to be secure against passive attacks and provide
  significant protection against active attacks. When using the
  Cryptographic authentication option, each router appends a "message
  digest" to its transmitted OSPF packets. Receivers then use the
  shared secret key and received digest to verify that each received
  OSPF packet is authentic.

  The quality of the security provided by the Cryptographic
  authentication option depends completely on the strength of the
  message digest algorithm (MD5 is currently the only message digest
  algorithm specified), the strength of the key being used, and the
  correct implementation of the security mechanism in all communicating
  OSPF implementations. It also requires that all parties maintain the
  secrecy of the shared secret key.

  None of the OSPF authentication types provide confidentiality. Nor do
  they protect against traffic analysis. Key management is also not
  addressed by this memo.

  For more information, see Sections 8.1, 8.2, and Appendix D.



















Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 210]

RFC 2178                     OSPF Version 2                    July 1997


Author's Address

  John Moy
  Cascade Communications Corp.
  5 Carlisle Road
  Westford, MA 01886

  Phone: 508-952-1367
  Fax:   508-692-9214
  Email: [email protected]









































Moy                         Standards Track                   [Page 211]